WO2015168079A1 - Dérivés de pyrimidine ou de pyridine utiles en tant qu'inhibiteurs de pi3k - Google Patents

Dérivés de pyrimidine ou de pyridine utiles en tant qu'inhibiteurs de pi3k Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2015168079A1
WO2015168079A1 PCT/US2015/027926 US2015027926W WO2015168079A1 WO 2015168079 A1 WO2015168079 A1 WO 2015168079A1 US 2015027926 W US2015027926 W US 2015027926W WO 2015168079 A1 WO2015168079 A1 WO 2015168079A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
alkyl
heteroaryl
compound
cycloalkyl
heterocyclyl
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2015/027926
Other languages
English (en)
Inventor
Alfredo C. Castro
Catherine A. Evans
Original Assignee
Infinity Pharmaceuticals, Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Infinity Pharmaceuticals, Inc. filed Critical Infinity Pharmaceuticals, Inc.
Publication of WO2015168079A1 publication Critical patent/WO2015168079A1/fr

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D403/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00
    • C07D403/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing two hetero rings
    • C07D403/12Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing two hetero rings linked by a chain containing hetero atoms as chain links
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D239/00Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,3-diazine or hydrogenated 1,3-diazine rings
    • C07D239/70Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,3-diazine or hydrogenated 1,3-diazine rings condensed with carbocyclic rings or ring systems
    • C07D239/72Quinazolines; Hydrogenated quinazolines
    • C07D239/86Quinazolines; Hydrogenated quinazolines with hetero atoms directly attached in position 4
    • C07D239/88Oxygen atoms
    • C07D239/90Oxygen atoms with acyclic radicals attached in position 2 or 3
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D401/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom
    • C07D401/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings
    • C07D401/12Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings linked by a chain containing hetero atoms as chain links
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D403/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00
    • C07D403/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing two hetero rings
    • C07D403/04Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing two hetero rings directly linked by a ring-member-to-ring-member bond
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D405/00Heterocyclic compounds containing both one or more hetero rings having oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, and one or more rings having nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • C07D405/02Heterocyclic compounds containing both one or more hetero rings having oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, and one or more rings having nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom containing two hetero rings
    • C07D405/04Heterocyclic compounds containing both one or more hetero rings having oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, and one or more rings having nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom containing two hetero rings directly linked by a ring-member-to-ring-member bond

Definitions

  • the activity of cells can be regulated by external signals that stimulate or inhibit intracellular events.
  • the process by which stimulatory or inhibitory signals are transmitted into and within a cell to elicit an intracellular response is referred to as signal transduction.
  • cascades of signal transduction events have been elucidated and found to play a central role in a variety of biological responses. Defects in various components of signal transduction pathways have been found to account for a vast number of diseases, including numerous forms of cancer, inflammatory disorders, metabolic disorders, vascular and neuronal diseases (Gaestel et al. Current Medicinal Chemistry (2007) 14:2214-2234).
  • Kinases represent a class of important signaling molecules. Kinases can generally be classified into protein kinases and lipid kinases, and certain kinases exhibit dual specificities. Protein kinases are enzymes that phosphorylate other proteins and/or themselves ⁇ i.e., autophosphorylation).
  • Protein kinases can be generally classified into three major groups based upon their substrate utilization: tyrosine kinases which predominantly phosphorylate substrates on tyrosine residues (e.g., erb2, PDGF receptor, EGF receptor, VEGF receptor, src, abl), serine/threonine kinases which predominantly phosphorylate substrates on serine and/or threonine residues (e.g., mTorCl, mTorC2, ATM, ATR, DNA-PK, Akt), and dual-specificity kinases which phosphorylate substrates on tyrosine, serine and/or threonine residues.
  • tyrosine kinases which predominantly phosphorylate substrates on tyrosine residues (e.g., erb2, PDGF receptor, EGF receptor, VEGF receptor, src, abl), serine/threonine kinases which predominantly phosphorylate substrates
  • Lipid kinases are enzymes that catalyze the phosphorylation of lipids. These enzymes, and the resulting phosphorylated lipids and lipid-derived biologically active organic molecules play a role in many different physiological processes, including cell proliferation, migration, adhesion, and differentiation. Certain lipid kinases are membrane associated and they catalyze the phosphorylation of lipids contained in or associated with cell membranes. Examples of such enzymes include phosphoinositide(s) kinases (e.g., PI3-kinases, PI4-Kinases), diacylglycerol kinases, and sphingosine kinases.
  • phosphoinositide(s) kinases e.g., PI3-kinases, PI4-Kinases
  • diacylglycerol kinases e.g., sphingosine kinases.
  • PI3Ks phosphoinositide 3-kinases
  • the phosphoinositide 3-kinases (PI3Ks) signaling pathway is one of the most highly mutated systems in human cancers.
  • PI3K signaling is also a key factor in many other diseases in humans.
  • PI3K signaling is involved in many disease states including allergic contact dermatitis, rheumatoid arthritis, osteoarthritis, inflammatory bowel diseases, chronic obstructive pulmonary disorder, psoriasis, multiple sclerosis, asthma, disorders related to diabetic complications, and inflammatory complications of the cardiovascular system such as acute coronary syndrome.
  • PI3Ks are members of a unique and conserved family of intracellular lipid kinases that phosphorylate the 3 ' -OH group on phosphatidylinositols or phosphoinositides.
  • the PI3K family comprises 15 kinases with distinct substrate specificities, expression patterns, and modes of regulation.
  • the class I PI3Ks (pi 10a, ⁇ ⁇ , ⁇ ⁇ , and ⁇ ⁇ ) are typically activated by tyrosine kinases or G-protein coupled receptors to generate l PIP3, which engages downstream effectors such as those in the Akt/PDKl pathway, mTOR, the Tec family kinases, and the Rho family GTPases.
  • the class II and III PI3Ks play a key role in intracellular trafficking through the synthesis of PI(3)P and PI(3,4)P2.
  • the PI3Ks are protein kinases that control cell growth (mTORCl) or monitor genomic integrity (ATM, ATR, DNA-PK, and hSmg-1).
  • PI3K-6 is expressed primarily in hematopoietic cells including leukocytes such as T-cells, dendritic cells, neutrophils, mast cells, B-cells, and macrophages.
  • leukocytes such as T-cells, dendritic cells, neutrophils, mast cells, B-cells, and macrophages.
  • PI3K-6 is integrally involved in mammalian immune system functions such as T-cell function, B-cell activation, mast cell activation, dendritic cell function, and neutrophil activity.
  • PI3K-6 Due to its integral role in immune system function, PI3K-6 is also involved in a number of diseases related to undesirable immune response such as allergic reactions, inflammatory diseases, inflammation mediated angiogenesis, rheumatoid arthritis, and auto-immune diseases such as lupus, asthma, emphysema and other respiratory diseases.
  • Other class I PI3K involved in immune system function includes PI3K- ⁇ , which plays a role in leukocyte signaling and has been implicated in inflammation, rheumatoid arthritis, and autoimmune diseases such as lupus.
  • beta ( ⁇ ) isoform of class I PI3K appears to be ubiquitously expressed.
  • ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ has been implicated primarily in various types of cancer including PTEN-negative cancer (Edgar et al. Cancer Research (2010) 70(3): 1164-1172), and HER2-overexpressing cancer such as breast cancer and ovarian cancer.
  • inhibitors capable of selectively inhibiting PI3K-5 and/or ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ , but without substantially affecting the activity of ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ are disclosed. Such inhibitors can be effective in ameliorating disease conditions associated with ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ / ⁇ activity.
  • Wt 1 and W b 2 are each independently CR 6 , S, O, N or NR 14 , wherein at least one of W b 1 and W b 2 is
  • Wt 5 is CR 8 , CHR 8 , or N;
  • p 0, 1, 2 or 3;
  • B is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl, each of which is substituted with 0-4 R 2 ;
  • each R 2 is independently alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea or carbonate;
  • X is absent or is -(CH(R 9 )) Z -;
  • each z is independently an integer of 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • R 3 is C 2 - 6 alkyl, fluoro, bromo, iodo, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 3 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond, either directly or through a Q-Q alkyl group, to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 3 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a cyclic moiety; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 ;
  • each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, heteroaryl, aryl, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • R 8 is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • each R 9 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl;
  • A is N or CR 19 ;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , R 13 , and R 19 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, haloalkyl, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, oxo, or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety;
  • each R 14 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl; and wherein the compound of Formula (I) is not one of the following compounds:
  • W b 1 and W b 2 are each independently CR 6 , S, O, N or NR 14 , wherein at least one of W b 1 and W b 2 is
  • W b 5 is CR 8 , CHR 8 , or N;
  • p 0, 1, 2 or 3;
  • B is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl, each of which is substituted with 0-4 R 2 ;
  • each R 2 is independently alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea or carbonate;
  • X is absent or is -(CH(R 9 )) Z -;
  • each z is independently an integer of 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • R 3 is C 2 - 6 alkyl, fluoro, bromo, iodo, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 3 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond, either directly or through a C ⁇ -C alkyl group, to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 3 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a cyclic moiety; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 ;
  • each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, heteroaryl, aryl, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • R 8 is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • each R 9 is alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl
  • W d is or CR 19 ;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , R 13 , and R 19 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, haloalkyl, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, oxo, or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety;
  • each R 14 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl; and wherein R 3 is not l-methyl-4-pyrazolyl.
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (II):
  • the compound of Formula (II) has a structure of Formula (Ila) or (lib):
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (IV):
  • the compound of Formula (IV) has a structure of Formula (V):
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (VI):
  • the compound of Formula (VI) has a structure of Formula (VII):
  • the compound of Formula (VI) has a structure of Formula (VIII):
  • the compound of Formula (VIII) has a structure of Formula (FX):
  • W b 1 and W b 2 are each independently CR 6 , S, O, N or NR 14 , wherein at least one ofW b 1 and W b 2 is
  • p 0, 1, 2 or 3;
  • B is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl, wherein cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl are substituted with 0-4 R 2 ;
  • each R 2 is independently alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxy carbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea or carbonate;
  • X is absent or is -(CH(R 9 )) Z -;
  • each z is independently an integer of 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, heteroaryl, aryl, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • each R 9 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl;
  • A is N or CR 19 ;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , R 13 , and R 19 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, oxo, or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety;
  • each R 14 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl;
  • R 18 is hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halo, alkoxy, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 18 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a Ci-Ce alkyl group to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 18 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered ring; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 ; and
  • the compound of Formula (XV) has a structure of Formula (XVI):
  • the compound of Formula (XVI) has a structure of Formula (XVII):
  • the compound of Formula (XV) has a structure of Formula (XVIII):
  • the compound of Formula (XVIII) has a structure of Formula (XVIV):
  • the compound of Formula (XV) has a structure of Formula (XX):
  • the compound of Formula (XX) has a structure of Formula (XXI):
  • W b 1 and W b 2 are each independently CR 6 , S, O, N or NR 14 , wherein at least one ofW b 1 and W b 2 is
  • each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, heteroaryl, aryl, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • each R is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl;
  • R 1 is -(L)-R 1 ;
  • R 1 is hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, substituted nitrogen,or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety;
  • p 0, 1, 2 or 3;
  • W b 5 is CR 8 or N
  • R 8 is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • R 17 is alkyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 17 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a C ⁇ -C alkyl group to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 17 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered ring; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 ;
  • X is absent or is -(CH(R 16 )) Z ;
  • each z is an integer of 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • each R 16 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, heteroalkyl, aryl, halo or heteroaryl;
  • W d is ;
  • A is N or CR 19 ;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , R 13 , and R 19 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, oxo, or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety.
  • a compound as provided herein selectively modulates phosphatidyl inositol-3 kinase (PI3 kinase) delta isoform.
  • the compound selectively inhibits the delta isoform over the beta isoform.
  • the ratio of selectivity can be greater than a factor of about 10, greater than a factor of about 50, greater than a factor of about 100, greater than a factor of about 200, greater than a factor of about 400, greater than a factor of about 600, greater than a factor of about 800, greater than a factor of about 1000, greater than a factor of about 1500, greater than a factor of about 2000, greater than a factor of about 5000, greater than a factor of about 10,000, or greater than a factor of about 20,000, where selectivity can be measured by IC 50 , among other means.
  • the PI3 kinase delta isoform IC 50 activity of a compound as provided herein can be less than about 1000 nM, less than about 100 nM, less than about 10 nM, or less than about 1 nM.
  • a composition e.g., a pharmaceutical composition
  • PI3 kinase phosphatidyl inositol-3 kinase
  • a method for inhibiting a phosphatidyl inositol-3 kinase (PI3 kinase) wherein said PI3 kinase is present in a cell.
  • the inhibition can take place in a subject suffering from a disorder selected from cancer, bone disorder, inflammatory disease, immune disease, nervous system disease (e.g., a neuropsychiatric disorder), metabolic disease, respiratory disease, thrombosis, and cardiac disease.
  • a second therapeutic agent is administered to the subject.
  • a method is provided of selectively inhibiting a phosphatidyl inositol -
  • Non- limiting examples of the methods provided herein can comprise contacting PI3 kinase delta isoform with an effective amount of a compound or pharmaceutical composition as provided herein. In an embodiment, such contact can occur in a cell.
  • a method is provided of selectively inhibiting a phosphatidyl inositol-
  • PI3 kinase delta isoform over PI3 kinase beta isoform wherein the inhibition takes place in a subject suffering from a disorder selected from cancer, bone disorder, inflammatory disease, immune disease, nervous system disease (e.g., a neuropsychiatric disorder), metabolic disease, respiratory disease, thrombosis, and cardiac disease, said method comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or pharmaceutical composition to said subject.
  • a disorder selected from cancer, bone disorder, inflammatory disease, immune disease, nervous system disease (e.g., a neuropsychiatric disorder), metabolic disease, respiratory disease, thrombosis, and cardiac disease
  • a method of treating a subject suffering from a disorder associated with phosphatidyl inositol-3 kinase comprising selectively modulating the phosphatidyl inositol-3 kinase (PI3 kinase) delta isoform over PI3 kinase beta isoform by administering an amount of a compound or pharmaceutical composition to said subject, wherein said amount is sufficient for selective modulation of PI3 kinase delta isoform over PI3 kinase beta isoform.
  • provided herein is a method of making a compound as described herein.
  • reaction mixture comprising a compound as described herein.
  • kits comprising a compound as described herein.
  • a method for treating a disease or disorder described herein comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or pharmaceutical composition described herein to a subject.
  • a method for treating a PI3K mediated disorder in a subject comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or pharmaceutical composition described herein to a subject.
  • provided herein is a use of a compound or a pharmaceutical composition described herein for the treatment of a disease or disorder described herein in a subject. [0039] In some embodiments, provided herein is a use of a compound or a pharmaceutical composition described herein for the treatment of a PI3K mediated disorder in a subject.
  • provided herein is a use of a compound or a pharmaceutical composition described herein in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a disease or disorder described herein in a subject.
  • a compound or a pharmaceutical composition described herein in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a PI3K mediated disorder in a subject.
  • heterocyclyl compounds and pharmaceutically acceptable forms, including, but not limited to, salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives thereof.
  • kits for treating and/or managing various diseases and disorders which comprises administering to a patient a therapeutically effective amount of a compound provided herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g. , salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g. , salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • kits for preventing various diseases and disorders which comprises administering to a patient in need of such prevention a prophylactically effective amount of a compound provided herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof.
  • a prophylactically effective amount of a compound provided herein or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof. Examples of diseases and disorders are described herein.
  • Second active agents include small molecules and large molecules (e.g. , proteins and antibodies), examples of which are provided herein, as well as stem cells.
  • Other methods or therapies that can be used in combination with the administration of compounds provided herein include, but are not limited to, surgery, blood transfusions, immunotherapy, biological therapy, radiation therapy, and other non-drug based therapies presently used to treat, prevent or manage various disorders described herein.
  • compositions e.g., single unit dosage forms
  • pharmaceutical compositions comprise a compound provided herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, and optionally one or more second active agents.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • agent or “biologically active agent” or “second active agent” refers to a biological, pharmaceutical, or chemical compound or other moiety.
  • Non-limiting examples include simple or complex organic or inorganic molecules, a peptide, a protein, an oligonucleotide, an antibody, an antibody derivative, an antibody fragment, a vitamin, a vitamin derivative, a carbohydrate, a toxin, or a chemotherapeutic compound, and metabolites thereof.
  • Various compounds can be synthesized, for example, small molecules and oligomers (e.g., oligopeptides and oligonucleotides), and synthetic organic compounds based on various core structures.
  • various natural sources can provide compounds for screening, such as plant or animal extracts, and the like. A skilled artisan can readily recognize that there is no limit as to the structural nature of the agents of this disclosure.
  • agonist refers to a compound or agent having the ability to initiate or enhance a biological function of a target protein or polypeptide, such as increasing the activity or expression of the target protein or polypeptide. Accordingly, the term “agonist” is defined in the context of the biological role of the target protein or polypeptide. While some agonists herein specifically interact with (e.g., bind to) the target, compounds and/or agents that initiate or enhance a biological activity of the target protein or polypeptide by interacting with other members of the signal transduction pathway of which the target polypeptide is a member are also specifically included within this definition.
  • antagonists are used interchangeably, and they refer to a compound or agent having the ability to inhibit a biological function of a target protein or polypeptide, such as by inhibiting the activity or expression of the target protein or polypeptide. Accordingly, the terms “antagonist” and “inhibitor” are defined in the context of the biological role of the target protein or polypeptide. While some antagonists herein specifically interact with (e.g., bind to) the target, compounds that inhibit a biological activity of the target protein or polypeptide by interacting with other members of the signal transduction pathway of which the target protein or polypeptide are also specifically included within this definition.
  • Non-limiting examples of biological activity inhibited by an antagonist include those associated with the development, growth, or spread of a tumor, or an undesired immune response as manifested in autoimmune disease.
  • an "anti-cancer agent”, “anti-tumor agent” or “chemotherapeutic agent” refers to any agent useful in the treatment of a neoplastic condition.
  • One class of anti-cancer agents comprises chemotherapeutic agents.
  • “Chemotherapy” means the administration of one or more chemotherapeutic drugs and/or other agents to a cancer patient by various methods, including intravenous, oral, intramuscular, intraperitoneal, intravesical, subcutaneous, transdermal, buccal, or inhalation or in the form of a suppository.
  • cell proliferation refers to a phenomenon by which the cell number has changed as a result of division. This term also encompasses cell growth by which the cell morphology has changed (e.g., increased in size) consistent with a proliferative signal.
  • co-administration encompasses administration of two or more agents to subject so that both agents and/or their metabolites are present in the subject at the same time.
  • Co-administration includes simultaneous administration in separate compositions, administration at different times in separate compositions, or administration in a composition in which both agents are present.
  • the term "effective amount” or “therapeutically effective amount” refers to that amount of a compound or pharmaceutical composition described herein that is sufficient to effect the intended application including, but not limited to, disease treatment, as illustrated below.
  • the therapeutically effective amount can vary depending upon the intended application (in vitro or in vivo), or the subject and disease condition being treated, e.g., the weight and age of the subject, the severity of the disease condition, the manner of administration and the like, which can readily be determined by one of ordinary skill in the art.
  • the term also applies to a dose that will induce a particular response in target cells, e.g., reduction of platelet adhesion and/or cell migration.
  • the specific dose will vary depending on, for example, the particular compounds chosen, the dosing regimen to be followed, whether it is administered in combination with other agents, timing of administration, the tissue to which it is administered, and the physical delivery system in which it is carried.
  • treatment As used herein, the terms “treatment”, “treating”, “palliating” and “ameliorating” are used interchangeably herein. These terms refer to an approach for obtaining beneficial or desired results including, but not limited to, therapeutic benefit and/or a prophylactic benefit.
  • therapeutic benefit is meant eradication or amelioration of the underlying disorder being treated.
  • a therapeutic benefit is achieved with the eradication or amelioration of one or more of the physiological symptoms associated with the underlying disorder such that an improvement is observed in the patient, notwithstanding that the patient can still be afflicted with the underlying disorder.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions can be administered to a patient at risk of developing a particular disease, or to a patient reporting one or more of the physiological symptoms of a disease, even though a diagnosis of this disease may not have been made.
  • a prophylactic effect includes delaying or eliminating the appearance of a disease or condition, delaying or eliminating the onset of symptoms of a disease or condition, slowing, halting, or reversing the progression of a disease or condition, or any combination thereof.
  • Signal transduction is a process during which stimulatory or inhibitory signals are transmitted into and within a cell to elicit an intracellular response.
  • a “modulator” of a signal transduction pathway refers to a compound which modulates the activity of one or more cellular proteins mapped to the same specific signal transduction pathway. A modulator can augment (agonist) or suppress (antagonist) the activity of a signaling molecule.
  • selective inhibition or “selectively inhibit” as applied to a biologically active agent refers to the agent's ability to selectively reduce the target signaling activity as compared to off- target signaling activity, via direct or interact interaction with the target.
  • a compound that selectively inhibits one isoform of PI3K over another isoform of PI3K has an activity of at least 2X against a first isoform relative to the compound's activity against the second isoform (e.g. , at least about 3X, 5X, 10X, 20X, 50X, or 100X).
  • Radionuclides e.g., actinium and thorium radionuclides
  • LET low linear energy transfer
  • beta emitters conversion electron emitters
  • high-energy radiation including without limitation x-rays, gamma rays, and neutrons.
  • Subject to which administration is contemplated includes, but is not limited to, humans ⁇ i.e. , a male or female of any age group, e.g. , a pediatric subject (e.g., infant, child, adolescent) or adult subject (e.g. , young adult, middle-aged adult or senior adult)) and/or other primates (e.g., cynomolgus monkeys, rhesus monkeys); mammals, including commercially relevant mammals such as cattle, pigs, horses, sheep, goats, cats, and/or dogs; and/or birds, including commercially relevant birds such as chickens, ducks, geese, quail, and/or turkeys.
  • a pediatric subject e.g., infant, child, adolescent
  • adult subject e.g., young adult, middle-aged adult or senior adult
  • primates e.g., cynomolgus monkeys, rhesus monkeys
  • mammals including commercially
  • in vivo refers to an event that takes place in a subject's body.
  • in vitro refers to an event that takes places outside of a subject's body.
  • an in vitro assay encompasses any assay conducted outside of a subject.
  • In vitro assays encompass cell- based assays in which cells, alive or dead, are employed.
  • In vitro assays also encompass a cell-free assay in which no intact cells are employed.
  • esters include, but are not limited to, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, aralkyl, and cycloalkyl esters of acidic groups, including, but not limited to, carboxylic acids, phosphoric acids, phosphinic acids, sulfonic acids, sulfuric acids and boronic acids.
  • a "pharmaceutically acceptable form” of a disclosed compound includes, but is not limited to, pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives of disclosed compounds.
  • a "pharmaceutically acceptable form” includes, but is not limited to, pharmaceutically acceptable salts, isomers, prodrugs and isotopically labeled derivatives of disclosed compounds.
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable form is a pharmaceutically acceptable salt.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable salt refers to those salts which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of subjects without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like, and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are well known in the art. For example, Berge et al. describes pharmaceutically acceptable salts in detail v& J. Pharmaceutical Sciences (1977) 66: 1-19.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds provided herein include those derived from suitable inorganic and organic acids and bases.
  • Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable, nontoxic acid addition salts are salts of an amino group formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid and perchloric acid or with organic acids such as acetic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, succinic acid or malonic acid or by using other methods used in the art such as ion exchange.
  • inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid and perchloric acid
  • organic acids such as acetic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, succinic acid or malonic acid or by using other methods used in the art such as ion exchange.
  • salts include adipate, alginate, ascorbate, aspartate, benzenesulfonate, besylate, benzoate, bisulfate, borate, butyrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, citrate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, formate, fumarate, glucoheptonate, glycerophosphate, gluconate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxy-ethanesulfonate, lactobionate, lactate, laurate, lauryl sulfate, malate, maleate, malonate, methanesulfonate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, nicotinate, nitrate, oleate, oxalate, palmitate, pamoate,
  • organic acids from which salts can be derived include, for example, acetic acid, propionic acid, glycolic acid, pyruvic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, malonic acid, succinic acid, fumaric acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, benzoic acid, cinnamic acid, mandelic acid, methanesulfonic acid, ethanesulfonic acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, salicylic acid, and the like.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts derived from appropriate bases include alkali metal, alkaline earth metal, ammonium and salts.
  • Representative alkali or alkaline earth metal salts include sodium, lithium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, iron, zinc, copper, manganese, aluminum, and the like.
  • Further pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, when appropriate, nontoxic ammonium, quaternary ammonium, and amine cations formed using counterions such as halide, hydroxide, carboxylate, sulfate, phosphate, nitrate, lower alkyl sulfonate and aryl sulfonate.
  • Organic bases from which salts can be derived include, for example, primary, secondary, and tertiary amines, substituted amines including naturally occurring substituted amines, cyclic amines, basic ion exchange resins, and the like, such as isopropylamine, trimethylamine, diethylamine, triethylamine, tripropylamine, and ethanolamine.
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable base addition salt is chosen from ammonium, potassium, sodium, calcium, and magnesium salts.
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable form is a "solvate” (e.g., a hydrate).
  • solvate refers to compounds that further include a stoichiometric or non-stoichiometric amount of solvent bound by non-covalent intermolecular forces.
  • the solvate can be of a disclosed compound or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. Where the solvent is water, the solvate is a "hydrate”.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable solvates and hydrates are complexes that, for example, can include 1 to about 100, or 1 to about 10, or one to about 2, about 3 or about 4, solvent or water molecules. It will be understood that the term "compound” as used herein encompasses the compound and solvates of the compound, as well as mixtures thereof.
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable form is a prodrug.
  • prodrug refers to compounds that are transformed in vivo to yield a disclosed compound or a pharmaceutically acceptable form of the compound.
  • a prodrug can be inactive when administered to a subject, but is converted in vivo to an active compound, for example, by hydrolysis (e.g., hydrolysis in blood).
  • a prodrug has improved physical and/or delivery properties over the parent compound.
  • Prodrugs are typically designed to enhance pharmaceutically and/or pharmacokinetic ally based properties associated with the parent compound.
  • the prodrug compound often offers advantages of solubility, tissue compatibility or delayed release in a mammalian organism ⁇ see, e.g., Bundgard, H., Design of Prodrugs (1985), pp. 7-9, 21-24 (Elsevier, Amsterdam).
  • a discussion of prodrugs is provided in Higuchi, T., et al., "Pro-drugs as Novel Delivery Systems," A. C.S. Symposium Series, Vol. 14, and in Bioreversible Carriers in Drug Design, ed. Edward B. Roche, American Pharmaceutical Association and Pergamon Press, 1987, both of which are incorporated in full by reference herein.
  • Exemplary advantages of a prodrug can include, but are not limited to, its physical properties, such as enhanced water solubility for parenteral administration at physiological pH compared to the parent compound, or it enhances absorption from the digestive tract, or it can enhance drug stability for long-term storage.
  • prodrug is also meant to include any covalently bonded carriers, which release the active compound in vivo when such prodrug is administered to a subject.
  • Prodrugs of an active compound, as described herein can be prepared by modifying functional groups present in the active compound in such a way that the modifications are cleaved, either in routine manipulation or in vivo, to the parent active compound.
  • Prodrugs include compounds wherein a hydroxy, amino or mercapto group is bonded to any group that, when the prodrug of the active compound is administered to a subject, cleaves to form a free hydroxy, free amino or free mercapto group, respectively.
  • prodrugs examples include, but are not limited to, acetate, formate and benzoate derivatives of an alcohol or acetamide, formamide and benzamide derivatives of an amine functional group in the active compound and the like.
  • Other examples of prodrugs include compounds that comprise -NO, -N0 2 , -ONO, or - ON0 2 moieties.
  • Prodrugs can typically be prepared using well-known methods, such as those described in Burger's Medicinal Chemistry and Drug Discovery, 172-178, 949-982 (Manfred E. Wolff ed., 5th ed., 1995), and Design of Prodrugs (H. Bundgaard ed., Elselvier, New York, 1985).
  • a prodrug can comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable ester formed by the replacement of the hydrogen atom of the acid group with a group such as (Ci-C 8 )alkyl, (C 2 - Ci 2 )alkanoyloxymethyl, l-(alkanoyloxy)ethyl having from 4 to 9 carbon atoms, 1 -methyl- l-(alkanoyloxy)-ethyl having from 5 to 10 carbon atoms, alkoxycarbonyloxymethyl having from 3 to 6 carbon atoms, 1- (alkoxycarbonyloxy)ethyl having from 4 to 7 carbon atoms, 1 -methyl- l-(alkoxycarbonyloxy)ethyl having from 5 to 8 carbon atoms, N-(alkoxycarbonyl)aminomethyl having from 3 to 9 carbon atoms, l-(N-(
  • a prodrug can be formed by the replacement of the hydrogen atom of the alcohol group with a group such as (Ci-C6)alkanoyloxymethyl, l-((Ci-C6)alkanoyloxy)ethyl, 1 -methyl- 1 -((C 1 -C 6 )alkanoyloxy)ethyl (C 1 -C 6 )alkoxycarbonyloxymethyl, N-(C 1 -C 6 )alkoxycarbonylaminomethyl, succinoyl, (Ci-C6)alkanoyl, a-amino(Ci-C4)alkanoyl, arylacyl and a-aminoacyl, or ⁇ -aminoacyl-a-aminoacyl, where each a-aminoacyl group is independently selected from the naturally occurring L-amino acids, P(0)(
  • a prodrug can be formed by the replacement of a hydrogen atom in the amine group with a group such as R-carbonyl, RO-carbonyl, NRR'-carbonyl where R and R' are each independently (C 1 -C 10 )alkyl, (C 3 -C 7 )cycloalkyl, benzyl, a natural ⁇ -aminoacyl or natural a-aminoacyl-natural ⁇ -aminoacyl,— C(OH)C(0)OY 1 wherein Y 1 is H, (C C 6 )alkyl or benzyl, -C(OY 2 )Y 3 wherein Y 2 is (C C 4 ) alkyl and Y 3 is (C C 6 )alkyl, carboxy(C C 6 )alkyl, amino(Ci-C 4 )alkyl or mono-N— or di-N,
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable form is an isomer.
  • “Isomers” are different compounds that have the same molecular formula.
  • “Stereoisomers” are isomers that differ only in the way the atoms are arranged in space.
  • the term “isomer” includes any and all geometric isomers and stereoisomers.
  • “isomers” include geometric double bond cis- and trans-isomers, also termed E- and Z- isomers; R- and S-enantiomers; diastereomers, (d)-isomers and (l)-isomers, racemic mixtures thereof; and other mixtures thereof, as falling within the scope of this disclosure.
  • Geometric isomers can be represented by the symbol which denotes a bond that can be a single, double or triple bond as described herein.
  • Substituents around a carbon-carbon double bond are designated as being in the "Z” or "E” configuration wherein the terms “Z” and are used in accordance with IUPAC standards. Unless otherwise specified, structures depicting double bonds encompass both the "E " and "Z” isomers.
  • a mixture of a pair of enantiomers in any proportion can be known as a "racemic” mixture.
  • the term “( ⁇ )” is used to designate a racemic mixture where appropriate.
  • “Diastereoisomers” are stereoisomers that have at least two asymmetric atoms, but which are not mirror-images of each other.
  • the absolute stereochemistry is specified according to the Cahn-Ingold-Prelog R-S system. When a compound is an enantiomer, the stereochemistry at each chiral carbon can be specified by either R or S.
  • Resolved compounds whose absolute configuration is unknown can be designated (+) or (-) depending on the direction (dextro- or levorotatory) which they rotate plane polarized light at the wavelength of the sodium D line.
  • Certain of the compounds described herein contain one or more asymmetric centers and can thus give rise to enantiomers, diastereomers, and other stereoisomeric forms that can be defined, in terms of absolute stereochemistry at each asymmetric atom, as (R)- or (S)-.
  • the present chemical entities, pharmaceutical compositions and methods are meant to include all such possible isomers, including racemic mixtures, optically substantially pure forms and intermediate mixtures.
  • Optically active (R)- and (S)- isomers can be prepared, for example, using chiral synthons or chiral reagents, or resolved using conventional techniques.
  • the "enantiomeric excess" or "% enantiomeric excess” of a composition can be calculated using the equation shown below.
  • a composition contains 90% of one enantiomer, e.g., the S enantiomer, and 10% of the other enantiomer, e.g., the R enantiomer.
  • compositions containing 90% of one enantiomer and 10% of the other enantiomer is said to have an enantiomeric excess of 80%.
  • Some compositions described herein contain an enantiomeric excess of at least about 50%, about 75%, about 90%, about 95%, or about 99% of the S enantiomer. In other words, the compositions contain an enantiomeric excess of the S enantiomer over the R enantiomer. In other embodiments, some compositions described herein contain an enantiomeric excess of at least about 50%, about 75%, about 90%, about 95%, or about 99% of the R enantiomer. In other words, the compositions contain an enantiomeric excess of the R enantiomer over the S enantiomer.
  • an isomer/enantiomer can, in some embodiments, be provided substantially free of the corresponding enantiomer, and can also be referred to as "optically enriched,” “enantiomerically enriched,” “enantiomerically pure” and “non-racemic,” as used interchangeably herein. These terms refer to compositions in which the percent by weight of one enantiomer is greater than the amount of that one enantiomer in a control mixture of the racemic composition (e.g., greater than 1 : 1 by weight).
  • an enantiomerically enriched preparation of the S enantiomer means a preparation of the compound having greater than about 50% by weight of the S enantiomer relative to the R enantiomer, such as at least about 75% by weight, further such as at least about 80% by weight.
  • the enrichment can be much greater than about 80% by weight, providing a "substantially enantiomerically enriched," “substantially enantiomerically pure” or a "substantially non-racemic" preparation, which refers to preparations of compositions which have at least about 85% by weight of one enantiomer relative to other enantiomer, such as at least about 90% by weight, and further such as at least about 95% by weight.
  • the compound provided herein is made up of at least about 90% by weight of one enantiomer. In other embodiments, the compound is made up of at least about 95%, about 98%, or about 99% by weight of one enantiomer.
  • the compound is a racemic mixture of (S)- and (R)- isomers.
  • provided herein is a mixture of compounds wherein individual compounds of the mixture exist predominately in an (S)- or (R)- isomeric configuration.
  • the compound mixture has an (S)- enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, about 99%, about 99.5%, or more.
  • the compound mixture has an (S)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55% to about 99.5%, greater than about about 60% to about 99.5%, greater than about 65% to about 99.5%, greater than about 70% to about 99.5%, greater than about 75% to about 99.5%, greater than about 80% to about 99.5%, greater than about 85% to about 99.5%, greater than about 90% to about 99.5%, greater than about 95% to about 99.5%, greater than about 96% to about 99.5%, greater than about 97% to about 99.5%, greater than about 98% to greater than about 99.5%, greater than about 99% to about 99.5%, or more.
  • the compound mixture has an (R)-enantiomeric purity of greater than about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, about 99 %, about 99.5% or more.
  • the compound mixture has an (R)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55% to about 99.5%, greater than about about 60% to about 99.5%, greater than about 65% to about 99.5%, greater than about 70% to about 99.5%, greater than about 75% to about 99.5%, greater than about 80% to about 99.5%, greater than about 85% to about 99.5%, greater than about 90% to about 99.5%, greater than about 95% to about 99.5%, greater than about 96% to about 99.5%, greater than about 97% to about 99.5%, greater than about 98% to greater than about 99.5%, greater than about 99% to about 99.5% or more.
  • the compound mixture contains identical chemical entities except for their stereochemical orientations, namely (S)- or (R)- isomers.
  • the mixture of identical chemical entities is a racemic mixture of (S)- and (R)- isomers.
  • the mixture of the identical chemical entities (except for their stereochemical orientations), contain predominately (S)-isomers or predominately (R)- isomers.
  • the (S)- isomers in the mixture of identical chemical entities are present at about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, about 99%, about 99.5% ,or more, relative to the (R)- isomers.
  • the (S)- isomers in the mixture of identical chemical entities are present at an (S)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55% to about 99.5%, greater than about about 60% to about 99.5%, greater than about 65% to about 99.5%, greater than about 70% to about 99.5%, greater than about 75% to about 99.5%, greater than about 80% to about 99.5%, greater than about 85% to about 99.5%, greater than about 90% to about 99.5%, greater than about 95% to about 99.5%, greater than about 96% to about 99.5%, greater than about 97% to about 99.5%, greater than about 98% to greater than about 99.5%, greater than about 99% to about 99.5% or more.
  • the (R)- isomers in the mixture of identical chemical entities are present at about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, about 99%, about 99.5%, or more, relative to the (S)- isomers.
  • the (R)- isomers in the mixture of identical chemical entities are present at a (R)- enantiomeric excess greater than about 55% to about 99.5%, greater than about about 60% to about 99.5%, greater than about 65% to about 99.5%, greater than about 70% to about 99.5%, greater than about 75% to about 99.5%, greater than about 80% to about 99.5%, greater than about 85% to about 99.5%, greater than about 90% to about 99.5%, greater than about 95% to about 99.5%, greater than about 96% to about 99.5%, greater than about 97% to about 99.5%, greater than about 98% to greater than about 99.5%, greater than about 99% to about 99.5%, or more.
  • Enantiomers can be isolated from racemic mixtures by any method known to those skilled in the art, including chiral high pressure liquid chromatography (HPLC), the formation and crystallization of chiral salts, or prepared by asymmetric syntheses. See, for example, Enantiomers, Racemates and Resolutions (Jacques, Ed., Wiley Interscience, New York, 1981); Wilen et al., Tetrahedron 33:2725 (1977); Stereochemistry of Carbon Compounds (E.L. Eliel, Ed., McGraw-Hill, NY, 1962); and Tables of Resolving Agents and Optical Resolutions p. 268 (E.L. Eliel, Ed., Univ. of Notre Dame Press, Notre Dame, IN 1972).
  • HPLC high pressure liquid chromatography
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable form is a tautomer.
  • tautomer is a type of isomer that includes two or more interconvertable compounds resulting from at least one formal migration of a hydrogen atom and at least one change in valency ⁇ e.g., a single bond to a double bond, a triple bond to a single bond, or vice versa).
  • Tautomerization includes prototropic or proton-shift tautomerization, which is considered a subset of acid-base chemistry.
  • Prototropic tautomerization or “proton-shift tautomerization” involves the migration of a proton accompanied by changes in bond order.
  • Tautomerizations ⁇ i.e., the reaction providing a tautomeric pair
  • Exemplary tautomerizations include, but are not limited to, keto-to-enol; amide-to-imide; lactam- to-lactim; enamine-to-imine; and enamine-to-(a different) enamine tautomerizations.
  • keto-enol tautomerization is the interconversion of pentane-2,4-dione and 4-hydroxypent-3-en-2-one tautomers.
  • tautomerization is phenol-keto tautomerization.
  • phenol-keto tautomerization is the interconversion of pyridin-4-ol and pyridin-4(lH)-one tautomers.
  • structures depicted herein are also meant to include compounds which differ only in the presence of one or more isotopically enriched atoms.
  • compounds having the present structures except for the replacement of a hydrogen by a deuterium or tritium, or the replacement of a carbon by 13 C- or 14 C-enriched carbon are within the scope of this disclosure.
  • the disclosure also embraces isotopically labeled compounds which are identical to those recited herein, except that one or more atoms are replaced by an atom having an atomic mass or mass number different from the atomic mass or mass number usually found in nature.
  • isotopes that can be incorporated into disclosed compounds include isotopes of hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorus, fluorine and chlorine, such as 2 H, 3 ⁇ 4 13 C, 14 C, 15 N, 18 0, 17 0, 31 P, 32 P, 35 S, 18 F, and 36 C1, respectively.
  • Certain isotopically- labeled disclosed compounds ⁇ e.g., those labeled with 3 H and 14 C) are useful in compound and/or substrate tissue distribution assays.
  • Tritiated ⁇ i.e., 3 H) and carbon-14 ⁇ i.e., 14 C isotopes can allow for ease of preparation and detectability. Further, substitution with heavier isotopes such as deuterium ⁇ i.e., 2 H) can afford certain therapeutic advantages resulting from greater metabolic stability (e.g., increased in vivo half-life or reduced dosage requirements).
  • Isotopically labeled disclosed compounds can generally be prepared by substituting an isotopically labeled reagent for a non-isotopically labeled reagent.
  • provided herein are compounds that can also contain unnatural proportions of atomic isotopes at one or more of atoms that constitute such compounds. All isotopic variations of the compounds as provided herein, whether radioactive or not, are encompassed within the scope of the present disclosure.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable carrier” or “pharmaceutically acceptable excipient” includes any and all solvents, dispersion media, coatings, antibacterial and antifungal agents, isotonic and absorption delaying agents and the like. The use of such media and agents for pharmaceutically active substances is well known in the art. Except insofar as any conventional media or agent is incompatible with the active ingredient, its use in the therapeutic compositions as provided herein is contemplated. Supplementary active ingredients can also be incorporated into the pharmaceutical compositions.
  • Ci_6 alkyl is intended to encompass, d, C 2 , C 3 , C 4 , C 5 , C 6 , Ci_ 6 , Ci_ 5 , C M , Ci_ 3 , Ci_ 2 , C 2 _ 6, C2-5, C2- , C2-3, C3_6, C3_5, Czi_6, C4_5, and C5_6 alkyl.
  • Alkyl refers to a straight or branched hydrocarbon chain radical consisting solely of carbon and hydrogen atoms, containing no unsaturation, having from one to ten carbon atoms (e.g. , C 1 -C 10 alkyl).
  • a numerical range such as “1 to 10” refers to each integer in the given range; e.g., "1 to 10 carbon atoms” means that the alkyl group can consist of 1 carbon atom, 2 carbon atoms, 3 carbon atoms, etc., up to and including 10 carbon atoms, although the present definition also covers the occurrence of the term "alkyl" where no numerical range is designated.
  • alkyl groups have 1 to 10, 1 to 6, or 1 to 3 carbon atoms.
  • Representative saturated straight chain alkyls include, but are not limited to, -methyl, -ethyl, -n-propyl, -n-butyl, -n-pentyl, and -n-hexyl; while saturated branched alkyls include, but are not limited to, -isopropyl, -sec-butyl, -isobutyl, -tert-butyl, -isopentyl, 2-methylbutyl, 3-methylbutyl, 2-methylpentyl, 3-methylpentyl, 4-methylpentyl, 2-methylhexyl, 3-methylhexyl, 4-methylhexyl, 5-methylhexyl, 2,3- dimethylbutyl, and the like.
  • alkyl is attached to the parent molecule by a single bond.
  • an alkyl group is optionally substituted by one or more of substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamid
  • Perhaloalkyl refers to an alkyl group in which all of the hydrogen atoms have been replaced with a halogen selected from fluoro, chloro, bromo, and iodo. In some embodiments, all of the hydrogen atoms are each replaced with fluoro. In some embodiments, all of the hydrogen atoms are each replaced with chloro. Examples of perhaloalkyl groups include -CF 3 , -CF 2 CF 3 , -CF 2 CF 2 CF 3 , -CC1 3 , -CFC1 2 , -CF 2 C1 and the like.
  • Alkyl-cycloalkyl refers to an -(alkyl)cycloalkyl radical where alkyl and cycloalkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for alkyl and cycloalkyl respectively.
  • the "alkyl-cycloalkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through the alkyl group.
  • alkenyl-cycloalkyl and alkynyl-cycloalkyl mirror the above description of “alkyl-cycloalkyl” wherein the term “alkyl” is replaced with “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” respectively, and “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” are as described herein.
  • Alkylaryl refers to an -(alkyl)aryl radical where aryl and alkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for aryl and alkyl respectively.
  • the “alkylaryl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through the alkyl group.
  • the terms "-(alkenyl)aryl” and “-(alkynyl)aryl” mirror the above description of "-(alkyl)aryl” wherein the term “alkyl” is replaced with “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” respectively, and “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” are as described herein.
  • Alkyl-heteroaryl refers to an -(alkyl)heteroaryl radical where heteroaryl and alkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heteroaryl and alkyl respectively.
  • the "alkyl-heteroaryl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through the alkyl group.
  • Alkyl-heterocyclyl refers to an -(alkyl)heterocycyl radical where alkyl and heterocyclyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heterocyclyl and alkyl respectively.
  • the "alkyl-heterocyclyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through the alkyl group.
  • alkenyl refers to a straight or branched hydrocarbon chain radical group consisting solely of carbon and hydrogen atoms, containing at least one double bond, and having from two to ten carbon atoms (i.e., C 2 -Cio alkenyl).
  • a numerical range such as “2 to 10” refers to each integer in the given range; e.g., "2 to 10 carbon atoms” means that the alkenyl group can consist of 2 carbon atoms, 3 carbon atoms, etc., up to and including 10 carbon atoms.
  • an alkenyl comprises two to eight carbon atoms.
  • an alkenyl comprises two to five carbon atoms (e.g., C 2 -Cs alkenyl).
  • the alkenyl is attached to the parent molecular structure by a single bond, for example, ethenyl (i.e., vinyl), prop-l-enyl (i.e., allyl), but-l-enyl, pent-l-enyl, penta-l,4-dienyl, and the like.
  • the one or more carbon-carbon double bonds can be internal (such as in 2-butenyl) or terminal (such as in 1-butenyl).
  • Examples of C2- 4 alkenyl groups include ethenyl (C 2 ), 1-propenyl (C 3 ), 2-propenyl (C 3 ), 1-butenyl (C 4 ), 2-butenyl (C 4 ), butadienyl (C 4 ) and the like.
  • Examples of C 2 -6 alkenyl groups include the aforementioned C 2 - alkenyl groups as well as pentenyl (C 5 ), pentadienyl (C 5 ), hexenyl (C 6 ) and the like. Additional examples of alkenyl include heptenyl (C 7 ), octenyl (Cg), octatrienyl (Cg) and the like.
  • an alkenyl group is optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulfonate,
  • Alkynyl refers to a straight or branched hydrocarbon chain radical group consisting solely of carbon and hydrogen atoms, containing at least one triple bond, having from two to ten carbon atoms (i.e., C 2 -Cio alkynyl).
  • a numerical range such as “2 to 10” refers to each integer in the given range; e.g., "2 to 10 carbon atoms” means that the alkynyl group can consist of 2 carbon atoms, 3 carbon atoms, etc., up to and including 10 carbon atoms.
  • an alkynyl comprises two to eight carbon atoms.
  • an alkynyl has two to five carbon atoms (e.g., C 2 -Cs alkynyl).
  • the alkynyl is attached to the parent molecular structure by a single bond, for example, ethynyl, propynyl, butynyl, pentynyl, hexynyl, and the like.
  • an alkynyl group is optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulfonate
  • alkoxy refers to the group -O-alkyl, including from 1 to 10 carbon atoms of a straight, branched, cyclic configuration and combinations thereof, attached to the parent molecular structure through an oxygen. Examples include methoxy, ethoxy, propoxy, isopropoxy, cyclopropyloxy, cyclohexyloxy and the like.
  • Lower alkoxy refers to alkoxy groups containing one to six carbons. In some embodiments, C 1 -C4 alkoxy is an alkoxy group which encompasses both straight and branched chain alkyls of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
  • an alkoxy group is optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulfonate,
  • alkenoxy and alkynoxy mirror the above description of “alkoxy” wherein the prefix “alk” is replaced with “alken” or “alkyn” respectively, and the parent “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” terms are as described herein.
  • a C ⁇ -C alkoxycarbonyl group is an alkoxy group having from 1 to 6 carbon atoms attached through its oxygen to a carbonyl linker.
  • the Q-Q designation does not include the carbonyl carbon in the atom count.
  • “Lower alkoxycarbonyl” refers to an alkoxycarbonyl group wherein the alkyl portion of the alkoxy group is a lower alkyl group.
  • C 1 -C4 alkoxy is an alkoxy group which encompasses both straight and branched chain alkoxy groups of from 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
  • an alkoxycarbonyl group is optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, pho
  • alkenoxycarbonyl and alkynoxycarbonyl mirror the above description of “alkoxycarbonyl” wherein the prefix “alk” is replaced with “alken” or “alkyn” respectively, and the parent “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” terms are as described herein.
  • Acyl refers to R-C(O)- groups such as, but not limited to, (alkyl)-C(O)-, (alkenyl)-C(O)-,
  • alkynyl C(O)-, (aryl)-C(O)-, (cycloalkyl)-C(O)-, (heteroaryl)-C(O)-, (heteroalkyl)-C(O)-, and (heterocycloalkyl)-C(O)-, wherein the group is attached to the parent molecular structure through the carbonyl functionality.
  • acyl radical which refers to the total number of chain or ring atoms of the, for example, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, cyclohexyl, heteroaryl or heterocycloalkyl portion plus the carbonyl carbon of acyl.
  • a C 4 -acyl has three other ring or chain atoms plus carbonyl. If the R radical is heteroaryl or heterocycloalkyl, the hetero ring or chain atoms contribute to the total number of chain or ring atoms.
  • R of an acyloxy group can be optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl,
  • R can be alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, heteroalkyl, heteroalkenyl, heteroalkynyl, aryl, cyclohexyl, heteroaryl or heterocycloalkyl, which are as described herein.
  • the acyloxy group is attached to the parent molecular structure through the oxygen functionality.
  • an acyloxy group is a Q-C4 acyloxy radical which refers to the total number of chain or ring atoms of the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, cyclohexyl, heteroaryl or heterocycloalkyl portion of the acyloxy group plus the carbonyl carbon of acyl, i.e., a Czracyloxy has three other ring or chain atoms plus carbonyl. If the R radical is heteroaryl or heterocycloalkyl, the hetero ring or chain atoms contribute to the total number of chain or ring atoms.
  • R of an acyloxy group is optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl,
  • Amino refers to a -N(R b ) 2 , -N(R b )R b -, or -R b N(R b )R b - radical group, where each R b is independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • a -N(R b ) 2 group When a -N(R b ) 2 group has two R b other than hydrogen, they can be combined with the nitrogen atom to form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, or 7- membered ring.
  • -N(R b ) 2 is meant to include, but not be limited to, 1 -pyrrolidinyl and 4-morpholinyl.
  • an amino group is optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulfonate, ure
  • amine and “amino” also refer to N-oxides of the groups -N + (H)(R a )0 " , and -N + (R a )(R a )0, R a as described above, where the N-oxide is bonded to the parent molecular structure through the N atom.
  • N-oxides can be prepared by treatment of the corresponding amino group with, for example, hydrogen peroxide or m-chloroperoxybenzoic acid. The person skilled in the art is familiar with reaction conditions for carrying out the N-oxidation.
  • Amide refers to a chemical moiety with formula -C(0)N(R b ) 2 or -NR b C(0)R b , where R b is independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • this radical is a C1-C4 amido or amide radical, which includes the amide carbonyl in the total number of carbons in the radical.
  • a -C(0)N(R b ) 2 has two R b other than hydrogen, they can be combined with the nitrogen atom to form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, or 7-membered ring.
  • N(R b ) 2 portion of a -C(0)N(R b ) 2 radical is meant to include, but not be limited to, 1 -pyrrolidinyl and 4-morpholinyl.
  • an amido R b group is optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulfon
  • amide or "amido” is inclusive of an amino acid or a peptide molecule. Any amine, hydroxy, or carboxyl side chain on the compounds described herein can be transformed into an amide group.
  • the procedures and specific groups to make such amides are known to those of skill in the art and can readily be found in reference sources such as Greene and Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, 3rd Ed., John Wiley & Sons, New York, NY, 1999, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • Aromatic or aryl refers to a radical with six to ten ring atoms (e.g., C 6 -C 10 aromatic or C 6 -
  • Cio aryl which has at least one ring having a conjugated pi electron system which is carbocyclic (e.g., phenyl, fluorenyl, and naphthyl).
  • carbocyclic e.g., phenyl, fluorenyl, and naphthyl
  • bivalent radicals formed from substituted benzene derivatives and having the free valences at ring atoms are named as substituted phenylene radicals.
  • bivalent radicals derived from univalent polycyclic hydrocarbon radicals whose names end in "-yl” by removal of one hydrogen atom from the carbon atom with the free valence are named by adding "-idene” to the name of the corresponding univalent radical, e.g., a naphthyl group with two points of attachment is termed naphthylidene.
  • a numerical range such as “6 to 10 aryl” refers to each integer in the given range; e.g., "6 to 10 ring atoms” means that the aryl group can consist of 6 ring atoms, 7 ring atoms, etc., up to and including 10 ring atoms.
  • an aryl moiety can be optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulf
  • Aralkyl or “arylalkyl” refers to an (aryl)alkyl- radical where aryl and alkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for aryl and alkyl respectively.
  • the “aralkyl/arylalkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through the alkyl group.
  • aralkenyl/arylalkenyl and “aralkynyl/arylalkynyl” mirror the above description of “aralkyl/arylalkyl” wherein the “alkyl” is replaced with “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” respectively, and the “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” terms are as described herein.
  • each R b is independnently selected from alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • Cyano refers to a -CN radical.
  • Cycloalkyl and “carbocyclyl” each refer to a monocyclic or poly cyclic radical that contains only carbon and hydrogen, and can be saturated or partially unsaturated. Partially unsaturated cycloalkyl groups can be termed “cycloalkenyl” if the carbocycle contains at least one double bond, or "cycloalkynyl” if the carbocycle contains at least one triple bond. Cycloalkyl groups include groups having from 3 to 10 ring atoms (i.e., C 3 -Ci 0 cycloalkyl).
  • cycloalkyl refers to each integer in the given range; e.g., "3 to 10 carbon atoms” means that the cycloalkyl group can consist of 3 carbon atoms, 4 carbon atoms, 5 carbon atoms, etc., up to and including 10 carbon atoms.
  • cycloalkyl also includes bridged and spiro- fused cyclic structures containing no heteroatoms.
  • the term also includes monocyclic or fused-ring polycyclic (i.e., rings which share adjacent pairs of ring atoms) groups. In some embodiments, it is a C 3 -Cg cycloalkyl radical.
  • C 3 -C5 cycloalkyl radical is a C 3 -C5 cycloalkyl radical.
  • cycloalkyl groups include, but are not limited to the following moieties:
  • C 3 _6 carbocyclyl groups include, without limitation, cyclopropyl (C 3 ), cyclobutyl (C 4 ), cyclopentyl (C 5 ), cyclopentenyl (C 5 ), cyclohexyl (C 6 ), cyclohexenyl (C 6 ), cyclohexadienyl (C 6 ) and the like.
  • C 3 _ 8 carbocyclyl groups include the aforementioned C 3 _ 6 carbocyclyl groups as well as cycloheptyl (C 7 ), cycloheptadienyl (C 7 ), cycloheptatrienyl (C 7 ), cyclooctyl (Q), bicyclo[2.2.1]heptanyl, bicyclo[2.2.2]octanyl, and the like.
  • Examples of C 3 _i 0 carbocyclyl groups include the aforementioned C 3 _ 8 carbocyclyl groups as well as octahydro-lii-indenyl, decahydronaphthalenyl, spiro[4.5]decanyl and the like.
  • a cycloalkyl group is optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulf
  • Cycloalkyl-alkyl refers to a -(cycloalkyl)alkyl radical where cycloalkyl and alkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for cycloalkyl and alkyl respectively.
  • the "cycloalkyl-alkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through the cycloalkyl group.
  • cycloalkyl-alkenyl and “cycloalkyl-alkynyl” mirror the above description of “cycloalkyl-alkyl” wherein the term “alkyl” is replaced with “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” respectively, and “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” are as described herein.
  • Cycloalkyl-heterocycloalkyl refers to a -(cycloalkyl)heterocycylalkyl radical where cycloalkyl and heterocycloalkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heterocycloalkyl and cycloalkyl respectively.
  • the "cycloalkyl- heterocycloalkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through the cycloalkyl group.
  • Cycloalkyl-heteroaryl refers to a -(cycloalkyl)heteroaryl radical where cycloalkyl and heteroaryl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heteroaryl and cycloalkyl respectively.
  • the "cycloalkyl-heteroaryl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through the cycloalkyl group.
  • a “covalent bond” or “direct bond” refers to a single bond joining two groups.
  • Ester refers to a radical of formula -COOR, where R is selected from alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl. Any amine, hydroxy, or carboxyl side chain on the compounds described herein can be esterified.
  • esters are known to those of skill in the art and can readily be found in reference sources such as Greene and Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, 3rd Ed., John Wiley & Sons, New York, NY, 1999, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • an ester group can be optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulfonate,
  • Ether refers to a -R b -0-R b - radical where each R b is independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • Halo means fluoro, chloro, bromo or iodo.
  • haloalkyl include alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl and alkoxy structures that are substituted with one or more halo groups or with combinations thereof.
  • fluoroalkyl and “fluoroalkoxy” include haloalkyl and haloalkoxy groups, respectively, in which the halo is fluorine, such as, but not limited to, trifluoromethyl, difluoromethyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethyl, l-fluoromethyl-2-fluoroethyl, and the like.
  • alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl and alkoxy groups are as defined herein and can be optionally further substituted as defined herein.
  • Heteroalkyl include alkyl, alkenyl and alkynyl radicals, respectively, which have one or more skeletal chain atoms selected from an atom other than carbon, e.g., oxygen, nitrogen, sulfur, phosphorus or combinations thereof.
  • a numerical range can be given, e.g., Q-C4 heteroalkyl which refers to the chain length in total, which in this example is 4 atoms long.
  • a -CH 2 OCH 2 CH 3 radical is referred to as a "C4" heteroalkyl, which includes the heteroatom center in the atom chain length description.
  • connection to the parent molecular strucuture can be through either a heteroatom or a carbon in the heteroalkyl chain.
  • an N-containing heteroalkyl moiety refers to a group in which at least one of the skeletal atoms is a nitrogen atom.
  • One or more heteroatom(s) in the heteroalkyl radical can be optionally oxidized.
  • One or more nitrogen atoms, if present, can also be optionally quaternized.
  • heteroalkyl also includes skeletal chains substituted with one or more nitrogen oxide (-0-) substituents.
  • heteroalkyl groups include, without limitation, ethers such as methoxyethanyl (-CH 2 CH 2 OCH 3 ), ethoxymethanyl (-CH 2 OCH 2 CH 3 ), (methoxymethoxy)ethanyl (-CH 2 CH 2 OCH 2 OCH 3 ), (methoxymethoxy)methanyl (-CH 2 OCH 2 OCH 3 ) and (methoxyethoxy)methanyl (-CH 2 OCH 2 CH 2 OCH 3 ) and the like; amines such as -CH 2 CH 2 NHCH 3j - CH 2 CH 2 N(CH 3 ) 2> -CH 2 NHCH 2 CH 3 , -CH 2 N(CH 2 CH 3 )(CH 3 ) and the like.
  • ethers such as methoxyethanyl (-CH 2 CH 2 OCH 3 ), ethoxymethanyl (-CH 2 OCH 2 CH 3 ), (methoxymethoxy)ethanyl (-
  • Heteroalkyl, heteroalkenyl, and heteroalkynyl groups can each be optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sul
  • Heteroalkyl-aryl refers to a -(heteroalkyl)aryl radical where heteroalkyl and aryl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heteroalkyl and aryl respectively.
  • the "heteroalkyl-aryl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through an atom of the heteroalkyl group.
  • Heteroalkyl-heteroaryl refers to a -(heteroalkyl)heteroaryl radical where heteroalkyl and heteroaryl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heteroalkyl and heteroaryl respectively.
  • the "heteroalkyl-heteroaryl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through an atom of the heteroalkyl group.
  • Heteroalkyl-heterocycloalkyl refers to a -(heteroalkyl)heterocycloalkyl radical where heteroalkyl and heterocycloalkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heteroalkyl and heterocycloalkyl respectively.
  • the "heteroalkyl- heterocycloalkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through an atom of the heteroalkyl group.
  • Heteroalkyl-cycloalkyl refers to a -(heteroalkyl)cycloalkyl radical where heteroalkyl and cycloalkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heteroalkyl and cycloalkyl respectively.
  • the "heteroalkyl-cycloalkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through an atom of the heteroalkyl group.
  • Heteroaryl or, alternatively, “heteroaromatic” refers to a refers to a radical of a 5-18 membered monocyclic or polycyclic (e.g., bicyclic or tricyclic) aromatic ring system (e.g., having 6, 10 or 14 ⁇ electrons shared in a cyclic array) having ring carbon atoms and 1-6 ring heteroatoms provided in the aromatic ring system, wherein each heteroatom is independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous and sulfur ("5-18 membered heteroaryl").
  • Heteroaryl polycyclic ring systems can include one or more heteroatoms in one or both rings.
  • a numerical range such as “5 to 18” refers to each integer in the given range; e.g., "5 to 18 ring atoms” means that the heteroaryl group can consist of 5 ring atoms, 6 ring atoms, etc., up to and including 18 ring atoms.
  • bivalent radicals derived from univalent heteroaryl radicals whose names end in "-yl” by removal of one hydrogen atom from the atom with the free valence are named by adding "-idene" to the name of the corresponding univalent radical, e.g., a pyridyl group with two points of attachment is a pyridylidene.
  • an N-containing "heteroaromatic” or “heteroaryl” moiety refers to an aromatic group in which at least one of the skeletal atoms of the ring is a nitrogen atom.
  • One or more heteroatom(s) in the heteroaryl radical can be optionally oxidized.
  • One or more nitrogen atoms, if present, can also be optionally quaternized.
  • Heteroaryl also includes ring systems substituted with one or more nitrogen oxide (-0-) substituents, such as pyridinyl N-oxides. The heteroaryl is attached to the parent molecular structure through any atom of the ring(s).
  • Heteroaryl also includes ring systems wherein the heteroaryl ring, as defined above, is fused with one or more aryl groups wherein the point of attachment to the parent molecular structure is either on the aryl or on the heteroaryl ring, or wherein the heteroaryl ring, as defined above, is fused with one or more cycloalkyl or heterocycyl groups wherein the point of attachment to the parent molecular structure is on the heteroaryl ring.
  • the point of attachment to the parent molecular structure can be on either ring, i.e., either the ring bearing a heteroatom (e.g., 2-indolyl) or the ring that does not contain a heteroatom (e.g., 5-indolyl).
  • a heteroatom e.g., 2-indolyl
  • a heteroatom e.g., 5-indolyl
  • a heteroaryl group is a 5-10 membered aromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 1-4 ring heteroatoms provided in the aromatic ring system, wherein each heteroatom is independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, and sulfur ("5-10 membered heteroaryl").
  • a heteroaryl group is a 5-8 membered aromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 1-4 ring heteroatoms provided in the aromatic ring system, wherein each heteroatom is independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, and sulfur ("5-8 membered heteroaryl").
  • a heteroaryl group is a 5-6 membered aromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 1-4 ring heteroatoms provided in the aromatic ring system, wherein each heteroatom is independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, and sulfur ("5-6 membered heteroaryl").
  • the 5-6 membered heteroaryl has 1-3 ring heteroatoms selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, and sulfur.
  • the 5-6 membered heteroaryl has 1-2 ring heteroatoms selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, and sulfur.
  • the 5-6 membered heteroaryl has 1 ring heteroatom selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, and sulfur.
  • heteroaryls include, but are not limited to, azepinyl, acridinyl, benzimidazolyl, benzindolyl, 1,3-benzodioxolyl, benzofuranyl, benzooxazolyl, benzo[d]thiazolyl, benzothiadiazolyl, benzo[£][l,4]dioxepinyl, benzo[b][l,4]oxazinyl, 1,4-benzodioxanyl, benzonaphthofuranyl, benzoxazolyl, benzodioxolyl, benzodioxinyl, benzoxazolyl, benzopyranyl, benzopyranonyl, benzofuranyl, benzofuranonyl, benzofurazanyl, benzothiazolyl, benzothienyl (benzothiophenyl), benzothieno[3,2-d]pyr
  • a heteroaryl moiety is optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulfonate
  • Heteroaryl-alkyl refers to a -(heteroaryl)alkyl radical where heteroaryl and alkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heteroaryl and alkyl respectively.
  • the "heteroaryl-alkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through any atom of the heteroaryl group.
  • Heteroaryl-heterocycloalkyl refers to an -(heteroaryl)heterocycloalkyl radical where heteroaryl and heterocycloalkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heteroaryl and heterocycloalkyl respectively.
  • the "heteroaryl- heterocycloalkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through an atom of the heteroaryl group.
  • Heteroaryl-cycloalkyl refers to an -(heteroaryl)cycloalkyl radical where heteroaryl and cycloalkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heteroaryl and cycloalkyl respectively.
  • the "heteroaryl-cycloalkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through a carbon atom of the heteroaryl group.
  • Heterocyclyl refers to any 3- to
  • a heterocyclyl group can be a monocyclic, bicyclic, tricyclic or tetracyclic ring system, wherein the polycyclic ring systems can be a fused, bridged or spiro ring system.
  • Heterocyclyl polycyclic ring systems can include one or more heteroatoms in one or both rings.
  • a heterocyclyl group can be saturated or partially unsaturated.
  • heterocycloalkenyl if the heterocyclyl contains at least one double bond
  • heterocycloalkynyl if the heterocyclyl contains at least one triple bond.
  • a numerical range such as “5 to 18” refers to each integer in the given range; e.g., "5 to 18 ring atoms” means that the heterocyclyl group can consist of 5 ring atoms, 6 ring atoms, etc., up to and including 18 ring atoms.
  • bivalent radicals derived from univalent heterocyclyl radicals whose names end in "-yl” by removal of one hydrogen atom from the atom with the free valence are named by adding "-idene" to the name of the corresponding univalent radical, e.g., a piperidine group with two points of attachment is a piperidylidene.
  • An N-containing heterocyclyl moiety refers to an non-aromatic group in which at least one of the ring atoms is a nitrogen atom.
  • the heteroatom(s) in the heterocyclyl radical can be optionally oxidized.
  • One or more nitrogen atoms, if present, can be optionally quaternized.
  • Heterocyclyl also includes ring systems substituted with one or more nitrogen oxide (-0-) substituents, such as piperidinyl N-oxides. The heterocyclyl is attached to the parent molecular structure through any atom of any of the ring(s).
  • Heterocyclyl also includes ring systems wherein the heterocycyl ring, as defined above, is fused with one or more carbocycyl groups wherein the point of attachment is either on the carbocycyl or heterocyclyl ring, or ring systems wherein the heterocyclyl ring, as defined above, is fused with one or more aryl or heteroaryl groups, wherein the point of attachment to the parent molecular structure is on the heterocyclyl ring.
  • a heterocyclyl group is a 3-10 membered non-aromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 1-4 ring heteroatoms, wherein each heteroatom is independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous and sulfur ("3-10 membered heterocyclyl").
  • a heterocyclyl group is a 5-8 membered non- aromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 1-4 ring heteroatoms, wherein each heteroatom is independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous and sulfur ("5-8 membered heterocyclyl").
  • a heterocyclyl group is a 5-6 membered non-aromatic ring system having ring carbon atoms and 1-4 ring heteroatoms, wherein each heteroatom is independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous and sulfur ("5-6 membered heterocyclyl").
  • the 5-6 membered heterocyclyl has 1-3 ring heteroatoms selected from nitrogen, oxygen phosphorous and sulfur.
  • the 5-6 membered heterocyclyl has 1-2 ring heteroatoms selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous and sulfur.
  • the 5-6 membered heterocyclyl has 1 ring heteroatom selected from nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous and sulfur.
  • Exemplary 3-membered heterocyclyls containing 1 heteroatom include, without limitation, azirdinyl, oxiranyl, thiorenyl.
  • Exemplary 4-membered heterocyclyls containing 1 heteroatom include, without limitation, azetidinyl, oxetanyl and thietanyl.
  • Exemplary 5-membered heterocyclyls containing 1 heteroatom include, without limitation, tetrahydrofuranyl, dihydrofuranyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl, dihydrothiophenyl, pyrrolidinyl, dihydropyrrolyl and pyrrolyl-2,5-dione.
  • Exemplary 5-membered heterocyclyls containing 2 heteroatoms include, without limitation, dioxolanyl, oxathiolanyl and dithiolanyl.
  • Exemplary 5-membered heterocyclyls containing 3 heteroatoms include, without limitation, triazolinyl, oxadiazolinyl, and thiadiazolinyl.
  • Exemplary 6-membered heterocyclyl groups containing 1 heteroatom include, without limitation, piperidinyl, tetrahydropyranyl, dihydropyridinyl, and thianyl.
  • Exemplary 6-membered heterocyclyl groups containing 2 heteroatoms include, without limitation, piperazinyl, mo holinyl, dithianyl, dioxanyl, and triazinanyl.
  • Exemplary 7-membered heterocyclyl groups containing 1 heteroatom include, without limitation, azepanyl, oxepanyl and thiepanyl.
  • Exemplary 8-membered heterocyclyl groups containing 1 heteroatom include, without limitation, azocanyl, oxecanyl and thiocanyl.
  • bicyclic heterocyclyl groups include, without limitation, indolinyl, isoindolinyl, dihydrobenzofuranyl, dihydrobenzothienyl, tetrahydrobenzothienyl, tetrahydrobenzofuranyl, tetrahydroindolyl, tetrahydroquinolinyl, tetrahydroisoquinolinyl, decahydroquinolinyl, decahydroisoquinolinyl, octahydrochromenyl, octahydroisochromenyl, decahydronaphthyridinyl, decahydro-l,8-naphthyridinyl, octahydropyrrolo[3,2-b]pyrrole, indolinyl, phthalimidyl, naphthalimidyl, chromanyl, chromenyl, 1H- benzo[e] [ 1
  • heterocyclyl moieties are optionally substituted by one or more substituents which independently include: acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, amidino, imino, azide, carbonate, carbamate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, ether, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulfon
  • Heterocyclyl-alkyl refers to a -(heterocyclyl)alkyl radical where heterocyclyl and alkyl are as provided herein and which are optionally substituted by one or more of the substituents described as suitable substituents for heterocyclyl and alkyl respectively.
  • the "heterocyclyl-alkyl” is bonded to the parent molecular structure through any atom of the heterocyclyl group.
  • heterocyclyl-alkenyl and “heterocyclyl-alkynyl” mirror the above description of “heterocyclyl-alkyl” wherein the term “alkyl” is replaced with “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” respectively, and “alkenyl” or “alkynyl” are as described herein.
  • Moiety refers to a specific segment or functional group of a molecule. Chemical moieties are often recognized chemical entities embedded in or appended to a molecule.
  • Niro refers to the -N0 2 radical.
  • Oxa refers to the -O- radical.
  • Phosphate refers to a radical, where each R b is independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • R a is hydrogen and depending on the pH, the hydrogen can be replaced by an appropriately charged counter ion.
  • R a is hydrogen and depending on the pH, the hydrogen can be replaced by an appropriately charged counter ion.
  • R a when R a is hydrogen and depending on the pH, the hydrogen can be replaced by an appropriately charged counter ion.
  • a "leaving group or atom” is any group or atom that will, under the reaction conditions, cleave from the starting material, thus promoting reaction at a specified site. Suitable non-limiting examples of such groups unless otherwise specified include halogen atoms, mesyloxy, p-nitrobenzensulphonyloxy, trifluoromethyloxy, and tosyloxy groups.
  • Protecting group has the meaning conventionally associated with it in organic synthesis, i.e., a group that selectively blocks one or more reactive sites in a multifunctional compound such that a chemical reaction can be carried out selectively on another unprotected reactive site and such that the group can readily be removed after the selective reaction is complete.
  • a variety of protecting groups are disclosed, for example, in T.H. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, Third Edition, John Wiley & Sons, New York (1999), incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • a hydroxy protected form is where at least one of the hydroxy groups present in a compound is protected with a hydroxy protecting group.
  • amines and other reactive groups can similarly be protected.
  • substituted or “substitution” mean that at least one hydrogen present on a group atom (e.g., a carbon or nitrogen atom) is replaced with a permissible substituent, e.g., a substituent which upon substitution for the hydrogen results in a stable compound, e.g., a compound which does not spontaneously undergo transformation such as by rearrangement, cyclization, elimination, or other reaction.
  • a "substituted” group can have a substituent at one or more substitutable positions of the group, and when more than one position in any given structure is substituted, the substituent is either the same or different at each position.
  • Substituents include one or more group(s) individually and independently selected from acyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxy, alkylaryl, cycloalkyl, aralkyl, aryl, aryloxy, amino, amido, azide, carbonate, carbonyl, heteroalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, halo, haloalkoxy, haloalkyl, ester, mercapto, thio, alkylthio, arylthio, thiocarbonyl, nitro, oxo, phosphate, phosphonate, phosphinate, silyl, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfonamidyl, sulfoxyl, sulfonate, urea, -Si(R a ) 3 , -OR a ,
  • a cycloalkyl substituent can have a halide substituted at one ormore ring carbons, and the like.
  • the protecting groups that can form the protective derivatives of the above substituents are known to those of skill in the art and can be found in references such as Greene and Wuts, above.
  • sil refers to a -Si(R b ) 3 radical where each R b is independently selected from alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • Sulfanyl each refer to the radical -S-R b , wherein R b is selected from alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • alkylthio refers to the "alkyl-S-” radical
  • arylthio refers to the "aryl-S-” radical, each of which are bound to the parent molecular group through the S atom.
  • sulfide can also each refer to the group -R b SH.
  • Sulfmyl or “sulfoxide” refers to the -S(0)-R b radical, wherein for “sulfmyl”, R b is H and for
  • R b is selected from alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • Sulfonyl or “sulfone” refers to the -S(0 2 )-R b radical, wherein R b is selected from hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • each R b is independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, haloalkyl, heteroalkyl (bonded through a chain carbon), cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycloalkyl (bonded through a ring carbon), heterocycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl (bonded through a ring carbon) or heteroarylalkyl, unless stated otherwise in the specification, each of which moiety can itself be optionally substituted as described herein.
  • the term designates a C1-C4 sulfonamido, wherein each R b in the sulfonamido contains 1 carbon, 2 carbons, 3 carbons, or 4 carbons total.
  • substituent groups are specified by their conventional chemical formulae, written from left to right, they equally encompass the chemically identical substituents that would result from writing the structure from right to left, e.g. , -CH 2 0- is equivalent to -OCH 2 -.
  • W b 1 and W b 2 are each independently CR 6 , S, O, N or NR 14 , wherein at least one of W b 1 and W b 2 is
  • W b 5 is CR 8 , CHR 8 , or N;
  • p 0, 1, 2 or 3;
  • B is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl, each of which is substituted with 0-4 R 2 ;
  • each R 2 is independently alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea or carbonate;
  • X is absent or is -(CH(R 9 )) Z -;
  • each z is independently an integer of 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • R 3 is C 2 _ 6 alkyl, fluoro, bromo, iodo, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 3 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond, either directly or through a C ⁇ -C(, alkyl group, to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 3 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a cyclic moiety; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 ; each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido,
  • R 8 is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • each R 9 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl;
  • A is N or CR 19 ;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , R 13 , and R 19 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, haloalkyl, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, oxo, or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety;
  • each R is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl; and wherein the compound of Formula (I) is not one of the following compounds:
  • R 3 when R 3 is l-methyl-4-pyrazolyl, B is not phenyl substituted with 0 occurrences of R 13 or cyclopropyl substituted with 0 occurrences of R 13 .
  • W b 1 and W b 2 are each independently CR 6 , S, O, N or NR 14 , wherein at least one of W b 1 and W b 2 is
  • W b 5 is CR 8 , CHR 8 , or N;
  • p 0, 1, 2 or 3;
  • B is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl, each of which is substituted with 0-4 R 2 ;
  • each R 2 is independently alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea or carbonate;
  • X is absent or is -(CH(R 9 )) Z -;
  • each z is independently an integer of 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • R 3 is C 2 - 6 alkyl, fluoro, bromo, iodo, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 3 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond, either directly or through a C ⁇ -C alkyl group, to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 3 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a cyclic moiety; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 ;
  • each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, heteroaryl, aryl, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • R 8 is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • each R 9 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , R 13 , and R 19 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, haloalkyl, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, oxo, or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety;
  • each R 14 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl; and wherein R 3 is not l-methyl-4-pyrazolyl.
  • W b 1 is CR 6 . In some embodiments, W b 1 is N. In some embodiments,
  • W b 1 is S. In some embodiments, W b 1 is O.
  • W b 2 is CR 6 . In some embodiments, W b 2 is N. In some embodiments,
  • W b 2 is S. In some embodiments, W b 2 is O.
  • W b 1 and W b 2 are CR 6 .
  • W b 1 is S and W b 2 is CR 6 .
  • W b 1 is S and W b 2 is N.
  • R 8 is hydrogen
  • each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, heteroaryl, aryl, hydroxyl, or nitro.
  • each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, alkoxy, halo, cyano, heteroaryl or aryl.
  • R 6 is hydrogen, alkyl, fluoroalkyl, alkoxy or aryl. In some embodiments, each R 6 is hydrogen.
  • p is 0 or 1. In certain embodiments, p is 0. In some embodiments, p is 1.
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (II):
  • the compound of Formula (II) has a structure of Formula (Ila) or (lib):
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (III):
  • the compound of Formula (II) has a structure of Formula (Ilia) or (Illb):
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (Illb):
  • R 3 is pyridyl substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 .
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (Illb), wherein R 3 is pyridyl substituted with 1 or 2 R 13 , wherein each occurance of R 13 is independently Ci_ 4 alkyl, C 3 . 6 cycloalkyl, C 3 . 6 heterocyclyl, Ci_ 4 alkoxy, halo, Ci_ 4 haloalkyl, hydroxyl, or oxo.
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (Illb), wherein R 3 is pyridyl substituted with 1 or 2 R 13 , wherein each occurance of R 13 is independently methyl, methoxy, or oxo.
  • R 3 is pyridyl substituted with 1 or 2 R 13 , wherein each occurance of R 13 is independently methyl, methoxy, or oxo.
  • X is -(CH(R 9 )) Z -.
  • z is 1. In some embodiments,
  • R 9 is Ci_io alkyl (e.g. , methyl). In some embodiments, R 9 is methyl.
  • Y is absent or -N(R 9 )-. In certain embodiments, Y is absent. In some embodiments, Y is -N(R 9 )-. In some embodiment R 9 is hydrogen.
  • X-Y is _ j n cer tain embodiments, X-Y is (S)-CH(CH 3 )-NH-. In certain embodiments, X-Y is (R)-CH(CH 3 )-NH-.
  • R 3 is C 2 -C 6 alkyl, fluoro, bromo, iodo, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 3 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a C ⁇ -C alkyl group to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 3 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered ring; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 .
  • R 3 is cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 3 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a C ⁇ -C alkyl group to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 3 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered ring; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 .
  • R 3 is cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, 6-10 membered heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 3 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a Ci-C 6 alkyl group to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 3 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered ring; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 .
  • R 3 is heteroaryl substituted with 0, 1, 2 or 3 R 13 .
  • R 3 is 6-10 membered heteroaryl substituted with 0, 1, 2 or 3 R 13 .
  • R 3 is 6- membered heteroaryl substituted with 0, 1, 2 or 3 R 13 .
  • R 3 is 6-membered heteroaryl substituted with 0 R 13 (e.g. , 4-pyridazinyl).
  • R 3 is 6-membered heteroaryl substituted with 1 R 13 (e.g.
  • R 3 is pyridyl substituted with 0, 1, 2 or 3 R 13 . In some embodiments, R 3 is pyridyl substituted with 1 or 2 R 13 . In some embodiments, R 3 is pyridyl substituted with 1 R 13 . In some embodiments, R 3 is pyridyl substituted with 2 R 13 . In some embodiments, the substituted pyridyl is a pyridinonyl.
  • R 3 is 9-membered heteroaryl substituted with 0, 1, 2 or 3 R 13 . In some embodiments, R 3 is 10-membered heteroaryl substituted with 0, 1, 2 or 3 R 13 .
  • R 3 is a fused 5/6-bicyclic heteroaryl substituted with 0, 1, 2 or 3 R 13 .
  • R 3 is a fused 5/6-bicyclic heteroaryl substituted with 0 R 13 (e.g., 5-lH-pyrrolo[2,3- b]pyridine). In some embodiments, R 3 is fused 6/6-bicyclic heteroaryl substituted with 0, 1, 2 or 3 R 13 . In some embodiments, R 3 is fused 6/6-bicyclic heteroaryl substituted with 0 R 13 (e.g. , 3-quinolinyl).
  • each occurance of R 13 is independently alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, alkoxy, amino, sulfonamido, halo, haloalkyl, hydroxyl, or oxo.
  • each occurance of R 13 is independently Ci_ 4 alkyl, C 3 . 6 cycloalkyl, C 3 . 6 heterocyclyl, Ci_ 4 alkoxy, halo, Ci_ 4 haloalkyl, hydroxyl, or oxo.
  • each occurance of R 13 is independently methyl, methoxy, halo, or oxo.
  • each occurance of R 13 is independently methyl, methoxy, or oxo.
  • -X-Y-Wa is selected from:
  • W d is
  • R is hydrogen. In some embodiments, R is amino.
  • R 11 is haloalkyl (e.g., trifluoromethyl). In some embodiments, R 11 is cyano. In some embodiments, R is amido.
  • R is hydrogen. In some embodiments, R is amino.
  • W d is
  • W d is
  • A is N.
  • A is CR 19 , wherein R 19 is hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, arylalkyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, heteroalkyl, amido, amino, halo, hydroxyl, alkoxy, or cyano.
  • R 19 is hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halo, amido, amino or cyano.
  • R is methyl
  • B is not phenyl or cyclopropyl substituted with 0 occurrences
  • R is l-methyl-4-pyrazolyl
  • B is not phenyl or cyclopropyl substituted with 0 occurrences of R .
  • R 3 when R 3 is chloro, R 11 is not hydrogen, methyl or trifluoromethyl.
  • R 3 is methyl and R 11 is cyano.
  • R 3 is chloro and R 11 is cyano.
  • Ri 0 is hydrogen and R 12 is -NH 2 .
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is hydrogen, cyano, halo, unsubstituted or substituted alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted alkynyl, or unsubstituted or substituted alkenyl. In some embodiments, at least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted aryl.
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl, which includes, but is not limited to, heteroaryl having a five membered ring, heteroaryl having a six membered ring, heteroaryl with at least one nitrogen ring atom, heteroaryl with two nitrogen ring atoms, monocylic heteroaryl, and bicylic heteroaryl.
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted heterocyclyl, which includes, but is not limited to, heterocyclyl with one nitrogen ring atom, heterocyclyl with one oxygen ring atom, heterocyclyl with one sulfur ring atom, 5 membered heterocyclyl, 6 membered heterocyclyl, saturated heterocyclyl, unsaturated heterocyclyl, heterocyclyl having an unsaturated moiety connected to the heterocyclyl ring, heterocyclyl substituted by oxo, and heterocyclyl substituted by two oxo.
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted cycloalkyl, including, but not limited to, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloalkyl, each of which can be substituted by one oxo, and cycloalkyl having an unsaturated moiety connected to the cycloalkyl ring.
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted amido, unsubstituted or substituted acyloxy, unsubstituted or substituted alkoxycarbonyl, unsubstituted or substituted acyl, or unsubstituted or substituted sulfonamido.
  • R 10 , R 11 and R 12 when at least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is alkyl, alkynyl, alkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, cycloalkyl, alkoxycarbonyl, amido, acyloxy, acyl, or sulfonamido, it is substituted with one or more of alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro, each of which alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl,
  • B is alkyl, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, or heteroaryl, each of which is substituted with 0-4 R 2 .
  • B is aryl (e.g. , 6-membered aryl) substituted with 0-4 occurrences of R 2 .
  • B is phenyl substituted with 0-4 occurrences of R 2 .
  • B is phenyl substituted with 0 occurrences of R 2 .
  • B is phenyl substituted with 1 occurrence of R 2 .
  • R 2 is halo (e.g., fluoro).
  • B is unsubstituted or substituted alkyl, including, but not limited to -
  • each R a is independently hydrogen, alkyl, fluoroalkyl, carbocyclyl, carbocyclylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkyl, heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl, or NR a R a are combined together to form a cyclic moiety, which includes, but is not limited to, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, and morpholinyl.
  • B is unsubstituted or substituted amino.
  • B is unsubstituted or substituted heteroalkyl.
  • B is alkyl or cycloalkyl substituted with 0-4 occurrences or R 2 . In some embodiments, B is isopropyl. [00207] In some embodiments, B is selected from unsubstituted or substituted aryl, including, but not limited to, unsubstituted or substituted phenyl; unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl including, but not limited to, pyridin-2-yl, pyridin-3-yl, pyridin-4-yl, pyrimidin-4-yl, pyrimidin-2-yl, pyrimidin-5-yl, or pyrazin-2-yl; unsubstituted or substituted monocyclic heteroaryl; unsubstituted or substituted bicyclic heteroaryl; a heteroaryl having two heteroatoms as ring atoms; unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl comprising a nitrogen ring atom; unsubstituted or substituted hetero
  • B is one of the following moieties:
  • R 2 is alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro, each of which alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl or sulfonamido, can itself be substituted.
  • R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted heteroalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted alkenyl, unsubstituted or substituted alkynyl, unsubstituted or substituted cycloalkyl, or unsubstituted or substituted heterocyclyl.
  • R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted aryl, unsubstituted or substituted arylalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl, or unsubstituted or substituted heteroarylalkyl.
  • R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted alkoxy, unsubstituted or substituted amido, or unsubstituted or substituted amino. In some embodiments, R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted acyl, unsubstituted or substituted acyloxy, unsubstituted or substituted alkoxycarbonyl, or unsubstituted or substituted sulfonamido. In some embodiments, R 2 is halo, selected from -I, -F, -CI, and -Br. In some embodiments, R 2 is selected from cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, and a carbonate.
  • R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted phosphate. In some embodiments, R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted urea. In some embodiments, when R 2 is alkyl, R 2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, n- butyl, tert- butyl, sec-butyl, pentyl, hexyl or heptyl.
  • R 2 when R 2 is alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, or hydroxyl, it is substituted by phosphate, substituted by urea, or substituted by carbonate.
  • R 2 when R 2 is alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or sulfonamido, it is substituted by one or more of alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro, each of which alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl
  • R 2 there are no occurrences of R 2 . In other embodiments, there is one occurrence of R 2 . In still other embodiments, there are two occurrences of R 2 . In yet other embodiments, there are three occurrences of R 2 . In yet other embodiments, there are four occurrences of R 2 .
  • B is aryl or heteroaryl and there are no occurrences of R 2 . In other instances, B is aryl or heteroaryl and there is one occurrence of R 2 where R 2 is alkyl or halo.
  • R 3 is hydrogen. In some embodiments, R 3 is unsubstituted or substituted alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted alkenyl, or unsubstituted or substituted alkynyl. In some embodiments, R 3 is unsubstituted or substituted aryl, unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl, unsubstituted or substituted cycloalkyl, or unsubstituted or substituted heterocyclyl. In some embodiments, R 3 is unsubstituted or substituted alkoxy, unsubstituted or substituted amido, or unsubstituted or substituted amino.
  • R 3 is unsubstituted or substituted acyl, unsubstituted or substituted acyloxy, or unsubstituted or substituted sulfonamido.
  • R 3 is halo, selected from -I, -F, -CI, and -Br.
  • R 3 is H, halo, alkyl, alkoxy, heteroaryl, or cycloalkyl.
  • R 3 is H, CH 3 , CH 2 CH 3 , CF 3 , CI, or F.
  • R 3 is CH 3 , CF 3 , or CI.
  • R 3 is selected from cyano, hydroxyl, and nitro.
  • R 3 when R 3 is alkyl, R 3 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, n- butyl, tert- butyl, sec -butyl, pentyl, hexyl or heptyl.
  • R 3 is -CF 3 , -CH 2 F or -CHF 2 .
  • R 3 when R 3 is alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, or sulfonamido, it is substituted with one or more of alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro, each of which alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or sulfonamido can itself be substitute
  • R 3 is a 5-membered heteroaryl group. Such groups include, for example, pyrrole, furan, thiophene, triazole, oxazole, pyrazole, and isoxazole.
  • R 3 is a 5- membered heterocycle, including, but not limited to, oxazoline and oxazolidinone.
  • R 3 is a 6-membered heteroaryl group including, but not limited to, pyridine, pyrazine, pyrimidine and pyridazine.
  • R 3 is a 6-membered heterocycle, including moieties such as mo holino or piperidino.
  • R 3 is a fused 5/6-bicyclic heteroaryl, for example, benzothiazole, benzoxazole, benzisoxazole, indazole, benzimidazole, benzothiophene, indole, isoindole, purine, or pyrazolopyrimidine.
  • R 3 is a fused 5/6-bicyclic heterocycle.
  • R 3 is a Q-Q alkyl group substituted with a 5-membered heteroaryl, a
  • R 3 is amino, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, or alkoxy where the N, S or O heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a C ⁇ -C(, alkyl group to a 5-membered heteroaryl, a 5-membered heterocycle, a 6-membered heteroaryl, a 6-membered heterocycle, a fused 5/6-bicyclic heteroaryl, or a fused 5/6-bicyclic nonaromatic heterocycle.
  • R 3 is a Ci-C 6 alkyl group substituted with a fused polycyclic group, wherein the polycyclic group has greater than two rings and is carbocyclic or heterocyclic; Ci-C 6 alkyl group substituted with a bridged cycloalkyl or bridged heterocyclic group; C r C 6 alkyl group substituted with a spirocyclic cycloalkyl or spirocyclic heterocyclic group; or branched C4-Q 2 alkyl group, wherein said branched alkyl group contains at least one terminal t-butyl group.
  • R 3 Each of the embodiments named above for R 3 is unsubstituted or optionally additionally substituted with an alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro group.
  • R 3 is a substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclyl or heteroaryl group selected from pyridine, pyrazole, piperazine, and pyrrolidine, wherein the substituent can be a Ci-C 6 alkyl group or a halogen.
  • a compound wherein R 3 is selected from a 5-membered heteroaryl such as a pyrrole, a furan, or a thiophene group; 5-membered nonaromatic heterocyclyl such as a pyrrolidine, a tetrahydrofuran, or a tetrahydrothiophene group; 6-membered heteroaryl such as pyridine, pyrazine, pyrimidine, or pyridazine; 6-membered nonaromatic heterocyclyl such as piperidine, tetrahydropyran, or thiane; and fused 5/6-bicyclic heteroaryl such as indole, isoindole, benzofuran, isobenzofuran, benzothiophene, benzimidazole, indazole, benzoxazole, benzisoxazole, or purine.
  • 5-membered heteroaryl such as a pyrrole, a furan
  • R 3 is a substituted or unsubstituted group such as pyridine, pyrazole, piperazine, or pyrrolidine.
  • the R 3 group can be substituted with a Ci-C 6 alkyl group or a halogen.
  • the R 3 group can be substituted with a methyl group.
  • R is H, C ⁇ - e alkyl, C ⁇ - e alkoxy, halo, and haloalkyl. In certain embodiments, R is methyl. In other embodiments, a compound is provided wherein R 3 is selected from:
  • X is absent. In some embodiments, X is -(CH(R 9 ) )Z and z is an integer of 1, 2, 3 or 4.
  • R 9 is unsubstituted or substituted alkyl including, but not limited to unsubstituted or substituted Ci-Ci 0 alkyl.
  • R 9 is unsubstituted or substituted cycloalkyl including, but not limited to unsubstituted or substituted C 3 -C 7 cycloalkyl.
  • R 9 is ethyl, methyl or hydrogen.
  • R 9 is unsubstituted or substituted heterocyclyl including, but not limited to, unsubstituted or substituted C 2 -Ci 0 heteroalkyl.
  • R 9 is unsubstituted or substituted heteroalkyl including, but not limited to, unsubstituted or substituted C 2 -Ci 0 heteroalkyl.
  • X is -(CH(R 9 )) Z
  • R 9 is not hydrogen
  • z is an integer of 1.
  • the compound can adopt either an (S)- or (R)-stereochemical configuration with respect to the CH carbon.
  • the compound is a racemic mixture of (S)- and (R) isomers with respect to the CH carbon.
  • the compound mixture has an (S)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, about 99%, about 99.5%, or more at the X carbon.
  • the compound mixture has an (S)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55% to about 99.5%, greater than about about 60% to about 99.5%, greater than about 65% to about 99.5%, greater than about 70% to about 99.5%, greater than about 75% to about 99.5%, greater than about 80% to about 99.5%, greater than about 85% to about 99.5%, greater than about 90% to about 99.5%, greater than about 95% to about 99.5%, greater than about 96% to about 99.5%, greater than about 97% to about 99.5%, greater than about 98% to greater than about 99.5%, greater than about 99% to about 99.5%, or more.
  • the compound mixture has an (R)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, about 99%, about 99.5%, or more at the CH carbon.
  • the compound mixture has an (R)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55% to about 99.5%, greater than about about 60% to about 99.5%, greater than about 65% to about 99.5%, greater than about 70% to about 99.5%, greater than about 75% to about 99.5%, greater than about 80% to about 99.5%, greater than about 85% to about 99.5%, greater than about 90% to about 99.5%, greater than about 95% to about 99.5%, greater than about 96% to about 99.5%, greater than about 97% to about 99.5%, greater than about 98% to greater than about 99.5%, greater than about 99% to about 99.5%, or more.
  • X is -CH(R 9 )-, R 9 is methyl or ethyl, and the compound is the (S)- isomer.
  • Y is absent.
  • N(R 9 )(C 0)NH-, -N(R 9 )C(R 9 ) 2 - (such as -N(R 9 )CH 2 -, including, but not limited to, -N(CH 3 )CH 2 -, N(CH(CH 3 ) 2 )CH 2 - or -N(CH 2 CH 3 )CH 2 -), -N(R 9 )-, -N(CH 3 )-, -N(CH 2 CH 3 )-, or -N(CH(CH 3 ) 2 )-.
  • X and Y are present.
  • -XY- is -CH 2 -, -CH 2 -N(CH 3 ), -CH 2 -N(CH 2 CH 3 ), -CH(CH 3 )-NH-, (S)-CH(CH 3 )-NH-, or (R)-CH(CH 3 )-NH-.
  • X-Y is -N(CH 3 ).CH 2 -, N(CH 2 CH 3 ) CH 2 -, -N(CH(CH 3 ) 2 )CH 2 -, or - NHCH 2 -.
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (TV):
  • the compound of Formula (IV) has a structure of Formula (V):
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (VI):
  • the compound of Formula (VI) has a structure of Formula (VII):
  • the compound of Formula (VI) has a structure of Formula (VIII):
  • the compound of Formula (VIII) has a structure of Formula (IX):
  • B is selected from the moieties presented in Table 1.
  • W b 1 and W b 2 are each independently CR 6 , S, O, N or NR 14 , wherein at least one ofW b 1 and W b 2 is
  • p 0, 1, 2 or 3;
  • B is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, amino, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl, wherein cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl are substituted with 0-4 R 2 ;
  • each R 2 is independently alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxy carbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea or carbonate;
  • X is absent or is -(CH(R 9 )) Z -;
  • each z is independently an integer of 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, heteroaryl, aryl, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • each R 9 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl;
  • A is N or CR 19 ;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , R 13 , and R 19 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, oxo, or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety;
  • each R 14 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl;
  • R 18 is hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halo, alkoxy, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 18 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a Ci-Ce alkyl group to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 18 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered ring; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 ; and
  • W b 1 is CR 6 . In some embodiments, W b 1 is N. In some embodiments,
  • W b 1 is S. In some embodiments, W b 1 is O.
  • W b 2 is CR 6 . In some embodiments, W b 2 is N. In some embodiments,
  • W b 2 is S. In some embodiments, W b 2 is O.
  • W b 1 and W b 2 are CR 6 .
  • W b 1 is S and W b 2 is CR 6 .
  • W b 1 is S and W b 2 is N.
  • p is 0. In some embodiments, p is 1.
  • R 18 is hydrogen, alkyl, halo, alkoxy, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 18 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a Q-Q alkyl group to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 18 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered ring; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 .
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is hydrogen, cyano, halo, unsubstituted or substituted alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted alkynyl, or unsubstituted or substituted alkenyl. In some embodiments, at least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted aryl.
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl, which includes, but is not limited to, heteroaryl having a 5 membered ring, heteroaryl having a six membered ring, heteroaryl with at least one nitrogen ring atom, heteroaryl with two nitrogen ring atoms, monocylic heteroaryl, and bicylic heteroaryl.
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted heterocyclyl, which includes, but is not limited to, heterocyclyl with one nitrogen ring atom, heterocyclyl with one oxygen ring atom, heterocyclyl with one sulfur ring atom, 5 membered heterocyclyl, 6 membered heterocyclyl, saturated heterocyclyl, unsaturated heterocyclyl, heterocyclyl having an unsaturated moiety connected to the heterocyclyl ring, heterocyclyl substituted by oxo, and heterocyclyl substituted by two oxo.
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted cycloalkyl, including, but not limited to, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloalkyl, each of which can be substituted by one oxo, and cycloalkyl having an unsaturated moiety connected to the cycloalkyl ring.
  • At least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is unsubstituted or substituted amido, unsubstituted or substituted acyloxy, unsubstituted or substituted alkoxycarbonyl, unsubstituted or substituted acyl, or unsubstituted or substituted sulfonamido.
  • R 10 , R 11 and R 12 when at least one of R 10 , R 11 and R 12 is alkyl, alkynyl, alkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, cycloalkyl, alkoxycarbonyl, amido, acyloxy, acyl, or sulfonamido, it is substituted with one or more of alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro, each of which alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl,
  • B is unsubstituted or substituted alkyl, including, but not limited to -
  • each R a is independently hydrogen, alkyl, fluoroalkyl, carbocyclyl, carbocyclylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkyl, heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl, or NR a R a are combined together to form a cyclic moiety, which includes but is not limited to piperidinyl, piperazinyl, and morpholinyl.
  • B is unsubstituted or substituted amino.
  • B is unsubstituted or substituted heteroalkyl.
  • B is selected from unsubstituted or substituted aryl, including, but not limited to, unsubstituted or substituted phenyl; unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl including, but not limited to, pyridin-2-yl, pyridin-3-yl, pyridin-4-yl, pyrimidin-4-yl, pyrimidin-2-yl, pyrimidin-5-yl, or pyrazin-2-yl; unsubstituted or substituted monocyclic heteroaryl; unsubstituted or substituted bicyclic heteroaryl; a heteroaryl having two heteroatoms as ring atoms; unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl comprising a nitrogen ring atom; unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl having two nitrogen ring atoms; unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl having a nitrogen and a sulfur as ring atoms; unsubstitute
  • B is one of the following moieties:
  • B is unsubstituted or substituted with one or more R 2 substituents.
  • R 2 is alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro, each of which alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl or sulfonamido, can itself be substituted.
  • R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted heteroalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted alkenyl, unsubstituted or substituted alkynyl, unsubstituted or substituted cycloalkyl, or unsubstituted or substituted heterocyclyl.
  • R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted aryl, unsubstituted or substituted arylalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl, or unsubstituted or substituted heteroarylalkyl.
  • R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted alkoxy, unsubstituted or substituted amido, or unsubstituted or substituted amino. In some embodiments, R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted acyl, unsubstituted or substituted acyloxy, unsubstituted or substituted alkoxycarbonyl, or unsubstituted or substituted sulfonamido. In some embodiments, R 2 is halo, selected from -I, -F, -CI, and -Br. In some embodiments, R 2 is selected from cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, and a carbonate.
  • R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted phosphate. In some embodiments, R 2 is unsubstituted or substituted urea. In some embodiments, when R 2 is alkyl, R 2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, n- butyl, tert- butyl, sec-butyl, pentyl, hexyl or heptyl.
  • R 2 when R 2 is alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, or hydroxyl, it is substituted by phosphate, substituted by urea, or substituted by carbonate.
  • R 2 when R 2 is alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or sulfonamido, it is substituted by one or more of alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro, each of which alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl
  • R 2 there are no occurrences of R 2 . In other embodiments, there is one occurrence of R 2 . In still other embodiments, there are two occurrences of R 2 . In yet other embodiments, there are three occurrences of R 2 . In yet other embodiments, there are four occurrences of R 2 .
  • B is aryl or heteroaryl and there are no occurrences of R 2 . In other instances, B is aryl or heteroaryl and there is one occurrence of R 2 where R 2 is alkyl or halo.
  • R 18 is hydrogen. In some embodiments, R 18 is unsubstituted or substituted alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted alkenyl, or unsubstituted or substituted alkynyl. In some embodiments, R 18 is unsubstituted or substituted aryl, unsubstituted or substituted heteroaryl, unsubstituted or substituted cycloalkyl, or unsubstituted or substituted heterocyclyl. In some embodiments, R 18 is unsubstituted or substituted alkoxy, unsubstituted or substituted amido, or unsubstituted or substituted amino.
  • R 18 is unsubstituted or substituted acyl, unsubstituted or substituted acyloxy, or unsubstituted or substituted sulfonamido.
  • R 18 is halo, selected from -I, -F, -CI, and -Br.
  • R 18 is H, halo, alkyl, alkoxy, heteroaryl, or cycloalkyl.
  • R 18 is H, CH 3 , CH 2 CH 3 , CF 3 , CI, or F. In some instances, R 18 is CH 3 , CF 3 , or CI.
  • R 18 is selected from cyano, hydroxyl, and nitro.
  • R 18 when R 18 is alkyl, R 18 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, n- butyl, tert- butyl, sec-butyl, pentyl, hexyl or heptyl.
  • R 18 is -CF 3 , -CH 2 F or -CHF 2 .
  • R 18 when R 18 is alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, or sulfonamido, it is substituted with one or more of alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro, each of which alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or sulfonamido can itself be substitute
  • R 18 is a 5-membered heteroaryl group. Such groups include, for example, pyrrole, furan, thiophene, triazole, oxazole, pyrazole, and isoxazole.
  • R 18 is a 5- membered heterocycle, including, but not limited to, oxazoline and oxazolidinone.
  • R 18 is a 6-membered heteroaryl group including, but not limited to, pyridine, pyrazine, pyrimidine and pyridazine.
  • R 18 is a 6-membered heterocycle, including moieties such as morpholino or piperidino.
  • R 18 is a fused 5/6-bicyclic heteroaryl, for example, benzothiazole, benzoxazole, benzisoxazole, indazole, benzimidazole, benzothiophene, indole, isoindole, purine, or pyrazolopyrimidine.
  • R 18 is a fused 5/6-bicyclic heterocycle.
  • R 18 is a Q-Q alkyl group substituted with a 5-membered heteroaryl, a
  • R 18 is amino, sulfmyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, or alkoxy where the N, S or O heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a C ⁇ -C(, alkyl group to a 5-membered heteroaryl, a 5-membered heterocycle, a 6-membered heteroaryl, a 6-membered heterocycle, a fused 5/6-bicyclic heteroaryl, or a fused 5/6-bicyclic nonaromatic heterocycle.
  • R 18 is a Q-Q alkyl group substituted with a fused polycyclic group, wherein the polycyclic group has greater than two rings and is carbocyclic or heterocyclic; Ci-C 6 alkyl group substituted with a bridged cycloalkyl or bridged heterocyclic group; Ci-C 6 alkyl group substituted with a spirocyclic cycloalkyl or spirocyclic heterocyclic group; or branched C 4 -Ci 2 alkyl group, wherein said branched alkyl group contains at least one terminal t-butyl group.
  • R 18 is unsubstituted or optionally additionally substituted with an alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, heteroaryl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl or nitro group.
  • R 18 is a substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclyl or heteroaryl group selected from pyridine, pyrazole, piperazine, and pyrrolidine, wherein the substituent can be a Ci-C 6 alkyl group or a halogen.
  • a compound wherein R 18 is selected from a 5-membered heteroaryl such as a pyrrole, a furan, or a thiophene group; 5-membered nonaromatic heterocyclyl such as a pyrrolidine, a tetrahydrofuran, or a tetrahydrothiophene group; 6-membered heteroaryl such as pyridine, pyrazine, pyrimidine, or pyridazine; 6-membered nonaromatic heterocyclyl such as piperidine, tetrahydropyran, or thiane; and fused 5/6-bicyclic heteroaryl such as indole, isoindole, benzofuran, isobenzofuran, benzothiophene, benzimidazole, indazole, benzoxazole, benzisoxazole, or purine.
  • a 5-membered heteroaryl such as a pyrrole, a
  • R 18 is a substituted or unsubstituted group such as pyridine, pyrazole, piperazine, or pyrrolidine.
  • the R 18 group can be substituted with a Ci-C 6 alkyl group or a halogen.
  • the R 18 group can be substituted with a methyl group.
  • R is H, Q-Q alkyl, Q-Q alkoxy, halo, and haloalkyl. In certain embodiments, R is methyl. In other embodiments, a compound is provided wherein R 18 is selected from:
  • X is absent. In some embodiments, X is -(CH( ) )Zi and z is an integer of 1, 2, 3 or 4.
  • R 9 is unsubstituted or substituted alkyl including, but not limited to unsubstituted or substituted Ci-Ci 0 alkyl.
  • R 9 is unsubstituted or substituted cycloalkyl including, but not limited to unsubstituted or substituted C 3 -C 7 cycloalkyl.
  • R 9 is ethyl, methyl or hydrogen.
  • R 9 is unsubstituted or substituted heterocyclyl including, but not limited to, unsubstituted or substituted C 2 -Ci 0 heteroalkyl.
  • R 9 is unsubstituted or substituted heteroalkyl including, but not limited to, unsubstituted or substituted C 2 -Ci 0 heteroalkyl.
  • X is -(CH(R 9 )) Z
  • R 9 is not hydrogen
  • z is an integer of 1.
  • the compound can adopt either an (S)- or (R)-stereochemical configuration with respect to the CH carbon.
  • the compound is a racemic mixture of (S)- and (R) isomers with respect to the CH carbon.
  • a mixture of compounds of Formula (XV) wherein individual compounds of the mixture exist predominately in an (S)- or (R)- isomeric configuration.
  • the compound mixture has an (S)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, about 99%, about 99.5%, or more at the X carbon.
  • the compound mixture has an (S)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55% to about 99.5%, greater than about about 60% to about 99.5%, greater than about 65% to about 99.5%, greater than about 70% to about 99.5%, greater than about 75% to about 99.5%, greater than about 80% to about 99.5%, greater than about 85% to about 99.5%, greater than about 90% to about 99.5%, greater than about 95% to about 99.5%, greater than about 96% to about 99.5%, greater than about 97% to about 99.5%, greater than about 98% to greater than about 99.5%, greater than about 99% to about 99.5%, or more.
  • the compound mixture has an (R)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, about 99%, about 99.5%, or more at the CH carbon.
  • the compound mixture has an (R)-enantiomeric excess of greater than about 55% to about 99.5%, greater than about about 60% to about 99.5%, greater than about 65% to about 99.5%, greater than about 70% to about 99.5%, greater than about 75% to about 99.5%, greater than about 80% to about 99.5%, greater than about 85% to about 99.5%, greater than about 90% to about 99.5%, greater than about 95% to about 99.5%, greater than about 96% to about 99.5%, greater than about 97% to about 99.5%, greater than about 98% to greater than about 99.5%, greater than about 99% to about 99.5%, or more.
  • the compound of Formula (XV), X is -CH(R 9 )-, R 9 is methyl or ethyl, and the compound is the (S)- isomer.
  • Y is absent.
  • N(R 9 )(C 0)NH-, -N(R 9 )C(R 9 ) 2 - (such as -N(R 9 )CH 2 -, including, but not limited to, -N(CH 3 )CH 2 -, N(CH(CH 3 ) 2 )CH 2 - or -N(CH 2 CH 3 )CH 2 -), -N(R 9 )-, -N(CH 3 )-, -N(CH 2 CH 3 )-, or -N(CH(CH 3 ) 2 )-.
  • X and Y are present.
  • -XY- is -CH 2 -, -CH 2 -N(CH 3 ), -CH 2 -N(CH 2 CH 3 ), -CH(CH 3 )-NH-, (S)-CH(CH 3 )-NH-, or (R)-CH(CH 3 )-NH-.
  • X-Y is -N(CH 3 ).CH 2 -, N(CH 2 CH 3 ) CH 2 -, -N(CH(CH 3 ) 2 )CH 2 -, or - NHCH 2 -.
  • the compound of Formula (XV) has a structure of Formula (XVI):
  • the compound of Formula (XVI) has a structure of Formula (XVII):
  • B is aryl substituted with 0-
  • B is phenyl substituted with 0-3 occurrences of R 2 .
  • B is unsubstituted phenyl.
  • B is phenyl substituted with 1 occurrence of R 2 .
  • R 2 is, in some instances, halo or alkyl.
  • B is cycloalkyl or heterocyclyl.
  • the compound of Formula (XV) has a structure selected from:
  • the compound of Formula (XV) has a structure of Formula (XVIII):
  • the compound of Formula (XVIII) has a structure of Formula (XVIV):
  • the compound of Formula (XV) has a structure of Formula (XX):
  • the compound of Formula (XX) has a structure of Formula (XXI):
  • B is selected from the moieties presented in Table 2.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • W b 1 and W b 2 are each independently CR 6 , S, O, N or NR 14 , wherein at least one of W b 1 and W b 2 is
  • each R 6 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, fluoroalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfoxide, sulfone, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, heteroaryl, aryl, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • each R 14 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroalkyl;
  • R 1 is -(L)-R 1 ;
  • R 1 is hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, substituted nitrogen,or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety;
  • p 0, 1, 2 or 3;
  • W b 5 is CR 8 or N
  • R 8 is alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heteroalkyl, alkoxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, or nitro;
  • R 17 is alkyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aralkyl, heteroaralkyl, heterocyclylalkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl, or R 17 is a heteroatom selected from N, S, and O, wherein the heteroatom has a covalent bond either directly or through a C ⁇ -C alkyl group to an aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, or R 17 and R 6 are taken together with the carbons to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered ring; wherein each of the above substituents can be substituted with 0, 1, 2, or 3 R 13 ;
  • X is absent or is -(CH(R 16 )) Z ;
  • each z is an integer of 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • each R 16 is independently hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, heteroalkyl, aryl, halo or heteroaryl;
  • A is N or CR 19 ;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , R 13 , and R 19 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, heteroalkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl, alkoxy, heterocyclyloxy, amido, amino, acyl, acyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, sulfonamido, halo, cyano, hydroxyl, nitro, phosphate, urea, carbonate, oxo, or NR'R" wherein R' and R" are taken together with nitrogen to form a cyclic moiety.
  • W,, 1 is CR 6 and W b 2 is CR 6 .
  • W b 5 is CH.
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (XXII):
  • the compound of Formula (XXII) has a structure of Formula (XXIII):
  • R 3 is aryl or heteroaryl
  • R 20 is amido or cyano.
  • R 3 is phenyl, pyrazolyl, or pyridyl, and R 20 is cyano.
  • R 3 is substituted phenyl or substituted pyridyl.
  • the substitutions are selected from alkyl, (e.g., methyl), heteroalkyl (e.g., CF 3 ), alkoxy, halo, amino, hydroxyl, cyano, aryl, heteroaryl, and sulfonamido.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • R 3 is pyridinone
  • a compound provided is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided is selected from the following:
  • R 3 is pyridyl and R 20 is amido. In certain embodiments, R 3 is pyridyl substituted with alkoxy.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • R 3 is pyrazolyl and R 20 is amido.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • the compound of Formula (XXII) has a structure of Formula (XXIV):
  • R 3 is alkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl.
  • R 3 is phenyl, triazole, or
  • R 3 is , wherein Ra is amino, and either D is nitrogen and E is carbon, or D is carbon and E is nitrogen.
  • a compound provided is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided is selected from the following:
  • the compound of Formula (I) has a structure of Formula (XXV):
  • R 3 is heteroaryl
  • R 3 is pyrimidinyl, pyridyl, or pyridanizyl.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the followin :
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the followin :
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • R 21 and R 22 are each independently hydrogen, methyl, chloro, or amino
  • R 23 is hydrogen, alkynyl, phenyl, cyano, methylsulfonyl or nitro;
  • R 21 is amino, then at least one of R 22 and R 23 is not H.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the followin '
  • R 24 is H, alkyl, or aryl.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • R is H or substituted alkyl (e.g. , alkyl substituted with amide).
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • R is selected from H, alkyl, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • R is selected from H, alkyl, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • R is selected from H, alkyl, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl.
  • R 27 is aryl, heteroaryl, -CO(NR 28 R 28 ), or -N-C(0)R 28 , and R 28 is selected from H, alkyl, heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl or heteroaryl.
  • R is substituted phenyl.
  • R is pyridinyl or substituted pyridinyl.
  • R is substituted phenyl.
  • R 27 is 2 K N J wherein Z is O, S, or NH; and R 29 is H, alkyl, or alkoxy.
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • a compound provided herein is selected from the following:
  • one or more compounds described herein bind to a PI3 kinase (e.g., bind selectively). In some embodiments, one or more compounds described herein bind selectively to
  • a ⁇ or ⁇ subtype of a PI3 kinase a ⁇ or ⁇ subtype of a PI3 kinase.
  • the IC 50 of a subject compound for pi 10a, ⁇ ⁇ , ⁇ ⁇ , or ⁇ ⁇ is less than about 1 ⁇ , less than about 100 nM, less than about 50 nM, less than about 10 nM, less than 1 nM or even less than about 0.5 nM. In some embodiments, the IC 50 of a subject compound for mTor is less than about 1 ⁇ , less than about 100 nM, less than about 50 nM, less than about 10 nM, less than 1 nM or even less than about 0.5 nM.
  • one or more subject compounds exhibit dual binding specificity and are capable of inhibiting a PI3 kinase (e.g., a class I PI3 kinase) as well as a protein kinase (e.g., mTor) with an IC 50 value less than about 1 ⁇ , less than about 100 nM, less than about 50 nM, less than about 10 nM, less than 1 nM or even less than about 0.5 nM.
  • a PI3 kinase e.g., a class I PI3 kinase
  • protein kinase e.g., mTor
  • One or more subject compounds are capable of inhibiting tyrosine kinases including, for example, DNA-dependent protein kinase (Pubmed protein accession number (PPAN) AAA79184), Abl tyrosine kinase (CAA52387), Bcr-Abl, hemopoietic cell kinase (PPAN CAI 19695), Src (PPAN CAA24495), vascular endothelial growth factor receptor 2 (PPAN ABB82619), vascular endothelial growth factor receptor-2 (PPAN ABB82619), epidermal growth factor receptor (PPAN AG43241), EPH receptor B4 (PPAN EAL23820), stem cell factor receptor (PPAN AAF22141), Tyrosine -protein kinase receptor TIE-2 (PPAN Q02858), fms-related tyrosine kinase 3 (PPAN NP_004110), platelet-derived growth factor receptor alpha (PPAN NP_9900
  • non-limiting exemplary compounds exhibit one or more functional characteristics provided herein.
  • one or more subject compounds bind specifically to a PI3 kinase.
  • the IC 50 of a subject compound for pl lOa, ⁇ ⁇ , ⁇ ⁇ , or pl l05 is less than about 1 ⁇ , less than about 100 nM, less than about 50 nM, less than about 10 nM, less than about 1 nM, less than about 0.5 nM, less than about 100 pM, or less than about 50 pM.
  • one or more of the subject compounds can selectively inhibit one or more members of type I or class I phosphatidylinositol 3-kinases (PI3-kinase) with an IC 50 value of about 100 nM, 50 nM, 10 nM, 5 nM, 100 pM, 10 pM or 1 pM, or less as measured in an in vitro kinase assay.
  • PI3-kinase phosphatidylinositol 3-kinases
  • one or more of the subject compounds can selectively inhibit one or two members of type I or class I phosphatidylinositol 3-kinases (PI3 -kinase) such as PI3 -kinase ⁇ , PI3 -kinase ⁇ , PI3- kinase ⁇ , and PI3-kinase ⁇ .
  • PI3 -kinase phosphatidylinositol 3-kinases
  • some of the subject compounds selectively inhibit PI3-kinase ⁇ as compared to all other type I PI3-kinases.
  • some of the subject compounds selectively inhibit PI3- kinase ⁇ and PI3-kinase ⁇ as compared to the rest of the type I PI3-kinases. In yet other aspects, some of the subject compounds selectively inhibit PI3-kinase a and PI3-kinase ⁇ as compared to the rest of the type I PI3-kinases. In still yet some other aspects, some of the subject compounds selectively inhibit PI3 -kinase ⁇ and PI3 -kinase a as compared to the rest of the type I PI3-kinases.
  • some of the subject compounds selectively inhibit PI3 -kinase ⁇ and PI3 -kinase ⁇ as compared to the rest of the type I PI3 -kinases, or selectively inhibit PI3 -kinase ⁇ and PI3 -kinase a as compared to the rest of the type I PI3 -kinases, or selectively inhibit PI3- kinase a and PI3 -kinase ⁇ as compared to the rest of the type I PI3 -kinases, or selectively inhibit PI3 -kinase ⁇ and PI3 -kinase ⁇ as compared to the rest of the type I PI3 -kinases.
  • an inhibitor that selectively inhibits one or more members of type I PI3- kinases or an inhibitor that selectively inhibits one or more type I PI3-kinase mediated signaling pathways, alternatively can be understood to refer to a compound that exhibits a 50% inhibitory concentration (IC 50 ) with respect to a given type I PI3-kinase, that is at least about 10-fold, at least about 20-fold, at least about 50-fold, at least about 100-fold, at least about 1000-fold, at least about 10,000-fold, or lower, than the inhibitor's IC 50 with respect to the rest of the other type I PI3 -kinases.
  • IC 50 50% inhibitory concentration
  • an inhibitor selectively inhibits PI3 -kinase ⁇ as compared to PI3 -kinase ⁇ with at least about 10-fold lower IC 50 for PI3 -kinase ⁇ .
  • the IC 50 for PI3-kinase ⁇ is below about 100 nM, while the IC 50 for PI3-kinase ⁇ is above about 1000 nM.
  • the IC 50 for PI3-kinase ⁇ is below about 50 nM, while the IC 50 for PI3-kinase ⁇ is above about 5000 nM.
  • the IC 50 for PI3 -kinase ⁇ is below about 10 nM, while the IC 50 for PI3 -kinase ⁇ is above about 1000 nM, above about 5,000 nM, or above about 10,000 nM.
  • compositions comprising one or more compounds as provided herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form thereof (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives), and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients carriers, including inert solid diluents and fillers, diluents, including sterile aqueous solution and various organic solvents, permeation enhancers, solubilizers and adjuvants.
  • a pharmaceutical composition described herein includes a second active agent such as an additional therapeutic agent, (e.g. , a chemotherapeutic).
  • compositions can be specially formulated for administration in solid or liquid form, including those adapted for the following: oral administration, for example, drenches (aqueous or non-aqueous solutions or suspensions), tablets (e.g., those targeted for buccal, sublingual, and systemic absorption), capsules, boluses, powders, granules, pastes for application to the tongue, and intraduodenal routes; parenteral administration, including intravenous, intraarterial, subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravascular, intraperitoneal or infusion as, for example, a sterile solution or suspension, or sustained-release formulation; topical application, for example, as a cream, ointment, or a controlled-release patch or spray applied to the skin; intravaginally or intrarectally, for example, as a pessary, cream, stent or foam; sublingually; ocularly; pulmonarily; local delivery by catheter or stent; intrathecally, or nasally.
  • oral administration for example
  • aqueous and nonaqueous carriers examples include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof, vegetable oils, such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters, such as ethyl oleate.
  • polyols such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like
  • vegetable oils such as olive oil
  • injectable organic esters such as ethyl oleate.
  • Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions, and by the use of surfactants.
  • compositions can also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents, dispersing agents, lubricants, and/or antioxidants.
  • adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents, dispersing agents, lubricants, and/or antioxidants.
  • Prevention of the action of microorganisms upon the compounds described herein can be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid, and the like.
  • isotonic agents such as sugars, sodium chloride, and the like into the compositions.
  • prolonged absorption of the injectable pharmaceutical form can be brought about by the inclusion of agents which delay absorption such as aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
  • Methods of preparing these formulations or compositions include the step of bringing into association a compound described herein and/or the chemotherapeutic with the carrier and, optionally, one or more accessory ingredients.
  • the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association a compound as provided herein with liquid carriers, or finely divided solid carriers, or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product.
  • the concentration of one or more of the compounds provided in the disclosed pharmaceutical compositions is less than about 100%, about 90%, about 80%, about 70%, about 60%, about 50%, about 40%, about 30%, about 20%, about 19%, about 18%, about 17%, about 16%, about 15%, about 14%, about 13%, about 12%, about 11%, about 10%, about 9%, about 8%, about 7%, about 6%, about 5%, about 4%, about 3%, about 2%, about 1%, about 0.5%, about 0.4%, about 0.3%, about 0.2%, about 0.1%, about 0.09%, about 0.08%, about 0.07%, about 0.06%, about 0.05%, about 0.04%, about 0.03%, about 0.02%, about 0.01%, about 0.009%, about 0.008%, about 0.007%, about 0.006%, about 0.005%, about 0.004%, about 0.003%, about 0.002%, about 0.001%, about 0.0009%, about 0.0008%, about 0.0007%
  • the concentration of one or more of the compounds as provided herein is greater than about 90%, about 80%, about 70%, about 60%, about 50%, about 40%, about 30%, about 20%, about 19.75%, about 19.50%, about 19.25% about 19%, about 18.75%, about 18.50%, about 18.25%, about 18%, about 17.75%, about 17.50%, about 17.25%, about 17%, about 16.75%, about 16.50%, about 16.25%, about 16%, about 15.75%, about 15.50%, about 15.25%, about 15%, about 14.75%, about 14.50%, about 14.25%, about 14%, about 13.75%, about 13.50%, about 13.25%, about 13%, about 12.75%, about 12.50%, about 12.25%, about 12%, about 11.75%, about 11.50%, about 11.25%, about 11%, about 10.75%, about 10.50%, about 10.25%, about 10%, about 9.75%, about 9.50%, about 9.25%, about
  • the concentration of one or more of the compounds as provided herein is in the range from approximately 0.0001% to approximately 50%, approximately 0.001% to approximately 40 %, approximately 0.01% to approximately 30%, approximately 0.02% to approximately 29%, approximately 0.03% to approximately 28%, approximately 0.04% to approximately 27%, approximately 0.05% to approximately 26%, approximately 0.06% to approximately 25%, approximately 0.07% to approximately 24%, approximately 0.08% to approximately 23%, approximately 0.09% to approximately 22%, approximately 0.1% to approximately 21%, approximately 0.2% to approximately 20%, approximately 0.3% to approximately 19%, approximately 0.4% to approximately 18%, approximately 0.5% to approximately 17%, approximately 0.6% to approximately 16%, approximately 0.7% to approximately 15%, approximately 0.8% to approximately 14%, approximately 0.9% to approximately 12%, approximately 1% to approximately 10% w/w, w/v or v/v. v/v.
  • the concentration of one or more of the compounds as provided herein is in the range from approximately 0.001% to approximately 10%, approximately 0.01% to approximately 5%, approximately 0.02% to approximately 4.5%, approximately 0.03% to approximately 4%, approximately 0.04% to approximately 3.5%, approximately 0.05% to approximately 3%, approximately 0.06% to approximately 2.5%, approximately 0.07% to approximately 2%, approximately 0.08% to approximately 1.5%, approximately 0.09% to approximately 1%, approximately 0.1% to approximately 0.9% w/w, w/v or v/v.
  • the amount of one or more of the compounds as provided herein is equal to or less than about 10 g, about 9.5 g, about 9.0 g, about 8.5 g, about 8.0 g, 7.5 g, about 7.0 g, about 6.5 g, about 6.0 g, about 5.5 g, about 5.0 g, about 4.5 g, about 4.0 g, about 3.5 g, about 3.0 g, about 2.5 g, about 2.0 g, about 1.5 g, about 1.0 g, about 0.95 g, about 0.9 g, about 0.85 g, about 0.8 g, about 0.75 g, about 0.7 g, about 0.65 g, about 0.6 g, about 0.55 g, about 0.5 g, about 0.45 g, about 0.4 g, about 0.35 g, about 0.3 g, about 0.25 g, about 0.2 g, about 0.15 g, about 0.1 g, about 0.09 g, about 0.08
  • the amount of one or more of the compounds as provided herein is more than about about 0.0001 g, about 0.0002 g, about 0.0003 g, about 0.0004 g, about 0.0005 g, about 0.0006 g, about 0.0007 g, about 0.0008 g, about 0.0009 g, about 0.001 g, about 0.0015 g, about 0.002 g, about 0.0025 g, about 0.003 g, about 0.0035 g, about 0.004 g, about 0.0045 g, about 0.005 g, about 0.0055 g, about 0.006 g, about 0.0065 g, about 0.007 g, about 0.0075 g, about 0.008 g, about 0.0085 g, about 0.009 g, about 0.0095 g, about 0.01 g, about 0.015 g, about 0.02 g, about 0.025 g, about 0.03 g, about 0.035 g,
  • the amount of one or more of the compounds as provided herein is in the range of about 0.0001 - about 10 g, about 0.0005 - about 9 g, about 0.001 - about 8 g, about 0.005 - about 7 g, about 0.01 - about 6 g, about 0.05 - about 5 g, about 0.1 - about 4 g, about 0.5 - about 4 g, or about 1 - about 3 g.
  • compositions for oral administration containing a compound as provided herein, and a pharmaceutical excipient suitable for oral administration.
  • pharmaceutical compositions for oral administration containing: (i) an effective amount of a disclosed compound; optionally (ii) an effective amount of one or more second agents; and (iii) one or more pharmaceutical excipients suitable for oral administration.
  • the pharmaceutical composition further contains: (iv) an effective amount of a third agent.
  • the pharmaceutical composition can be a liquid pharmaceutical composition suitable for oral consumption.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions suitable for oral administration can be presented as discrete dosage forms, such as capsules, cachets, or tablets, or liquids or aerosol sprays each containing a predetermined amount of an active ingredient as a powder or in granules, a solution, or a suspension in an aqueous or non-aqueous liquid, an oil-in-water emulsion, or a water-in-oil liquid emulsion.
  • Such dosage forms can be prepared by any of the methods of pharmacy, but all methods include the step of bringing the active ingredient into association with the carrier, which constitutes one or more ingredients.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions are prepared by uniformly and intimately admixing the active ingredient with liquid carriers or finely divided solid carriers or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product into the desired presentation.
  • a tablet can be prepared by compression or molding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients.
  • Compressed tablets can be prepared by compressing in a suitable machine the active ingredient in a free-flowing form such as powder or granules, optionally mixed with an excipient such as, but not limited to, a binder, a lubricant, an inert diluent, and/or a surface active or dispersing agent.
  • Molded tablets can be made by molding in a suitable machine a mixture of the powdered compound moistened with an inert liquid diluent.
  • the present disclosure further encompasses anhydrous pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms comprising an active ingredient, since water can facilitate the degradation of some compounds.
  • water can be added (e.g., about 5%) in the pharmaceutical arts as a means of simulating long-term storage in order to determine characteristics such as shelf-life or the stability of formulations over time.
  • Anhydrous pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms can be prepared using anhydrous or low moisture containing ingredients and low moisture or low humidity conditions.
  • pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms which contain lactose can be made anhydrous if substantial contact with moisture and/or humidity during manufacturing, packaging, and/or storage is expected.
  • An anhydrous pharmaceutical composition can be prepared and stored such that its anhydrous nature is maintained.
  • anhydrous pharmaceutical compositions can be packaged using materials known to prevent exposure to water such that they can be included in suitable formulary kits.
  • suitable packaging include, but are not limited to, hermetically sealed foils, plastic or the like, unit dose containers, blister packs, and strip packs.
  • An active ingredient can be combined in an intimate admixture with a pharmaceutical carrier according to conventional pharmaceutical compounding techniques.
  • the carrier can take a wide variety of forms depending on the form of preparation desired for administration.
  • any of the usual pharmaceutical media can be employed as carriers, such as, for example, water, glycols, oils, alcohols, flavoring agents, preservatives, coloring agents, and the like in the case of oral liquid preparations (such as suspensions, solutions, and elixirs) or aerosols; or carriers such as starches, sugars, micro- crystalline cellulose, diluents, granulating agents, lubricants, binders, and disintegrating agents can be used in the case of oral solid preparations, in some embodiments without employing the use of lactose.
  • suitable carriers include powders, capsules, and tablets, with the solid oral preparations. In some embodiments, tablets can be coated by standard aqueous or nonaqueous techniques.
  • Binders suitable for use in pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms include, but are not limited to, corn starch, potato starch, or other starches, gelatin, natural and synthetic gums such as acacia, sodium alginate, alginic acid, other alginates, powdered tragacanth, guar gum, cellulose and its derivatives (e.g., ethyl cellulose, cellulose acetate, carboxymethyl cellulose calcium, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose), polyvinyl pyrrolidone, methyl cellulose, pre-gelatinized starch, hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose, microcrystalline cellulose, and mixtures thereof.
  • natural and synthetic gums such as acacia, sodium alginate, alginic acid, other alginates, powdered tragacanth, guar gum, cellulose and its derivatives (e.g., ethyl cellulose, cellulose acetate, carboxymethyl cellulose calcium, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose), polyvinyl pyrrol
  • suitable fillers for use in the pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms provided herein include, but are not limited to, talc, calcium carbonate (e.g., granules or powder), microcrystalline cellulose, powdered cellulose, dextrates, kaolin, mannitol, silicic acid, sorbitol, starch, pre-gelatinized starch, and mixtures thereof.
  • Disintegrants can be used in the pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein to provide tablets that disintegrate when exposed to an aqueous environment. Too much of a disintegrant can produce tablets which can disintegrate in the bottle. Too little can be insufficient for disintegration to occur and can thus alter the rate and extent of release of the active ingredient(s) from the dosage form. Thus, a sufficient amount of disintegrant that is neither too little nor too much to detrimentally alter the release of the active ingredient(s) can be used to form the dosage forms of the compounds provided herein. The amount of disintegrant used can vary based upon the type of formulation and mode of administration, and can be readily discernible to those of ordinary skill in the art.
  • Disintegrants that can be used to form pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms include, but are not limited to, agar-agar, alginic acid, calcium carbonate, microcrystalline cellulose, croscarmellose sodium, crospovidone, polacrilin potassium, sodium starch glycolate, potato or tapioca starch, other starches, pre-gelatinized starch, other starches, clays, other algins, other celluloses, gums or mixtures thereof.
  • Lubricants which can be used to form pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms include, but are not limited to, calcium stearate, magnesium stearate, mineral oil, light mineral oil, glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol, polyethylene glycol, other glycols, stearic acid, sodium lauryl sulfate, talc, hydrogenated vegetable oil (e.g., peanut oil, cottonseed oil, sunflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil, and soybean oil), zinc stearate, ethyl oleate, ethylaureate, agar, or mixtures thereof.
  • calcium stearate e.g., magnesium stearate, mineral oil, light mineral oil, glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol, polyethylene glycol, other glycols, stearic acid, sodium lauryl sulfate, talc
  • hydrogenated vegetable oil e.g., peanut oil, cottonseed oil, sunflower oil
  • Additional lubricants include, for example, a syloid silica gel, a coagulated aerosol of synthetic silica, or mixtures thereof.
  • a lubricant can optionally be added, in an amount of less than about 1 weight percent of the pharmaceutical composition.
  • the active ingredient therein can be combined with various sweetening or flavoring agents, coloring matter or dyes and, for example, emulsifying and/or suspending agents, together with such diluents as water, ethanol, propylene glycol, glycerin and various combinations thereof.
  • the tablets can be uncoated or coated by known techniques to delay disintegration and absorption in the gastrointestinal tract and thereby provide a sustained action over a longer period.
  • a time delay material such as glyceryl monostearate or glyceryl distearate can be employed.
  • Formulations for oral use can also be presented as hard gelatin capsules wherein the active ingredient is mixed with an inert solid diluent, for example, calcium carbonate, calcium phosphate or kaolin, or as soft gelatin capsules wherein the active ingredient is mixed with water or an oil medium, for example, peanut oil, liquid paraffin or olive oil.
  • Surfactant which can be used to form pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms include, but are not limited to, hydrophilic surfactants, lipophilic surfactants, and mixtures thereof. That is, a mixture of hydrophilic surfactants can be employed, a mixture of lipophilic surfactants can be employed, or a mixture of at least one hydrophilic surfactant and at least one lipophilic surfactant can be employed.
  • a suitable hydrophilic surfactant can generally have an HLB value of at least about 10, while suitable lipophilic surfactants can generally have an HLB value of or less than about 10.
  • An empirical parameter used to characterize the relative hydrophilicity and hydrophobicity of non-ionic amphiphilic compounds is the hydrophilic-lipophilic balance ("HLB" value).
  • HLB hydrophilic-lipophilic balance
  • Surfactants with lower HLB values are more lipophilic or hydrophobic, and have greater solubility in oils, while surfactants with higher HLB values are more hydrophilic, and have greater solubility in aqueous solutions.
  • Hydrophilic surfactants are generally considered to be those compounds having an HLB value greater than about 10, as well as anionic, cationic, or zwitterionic compounds for which the HLB scale is not generally applicable.
  • lipophilic (i.e., hydrophobic) surfactants are compounds having an HLB value equal to or less than about 10.
  • HLB value of a surfactant is merely a rough guide generally used to enable formulation of industrial, pharmaceutical and cosmetic emulsions.
  • Hydrophilic surfactants can be either ionic or non-ionic. Suitable ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to, alkylammonium salts; fusidic acid salts; fatty acid derivatives of amino acids, oligopeptides, and polypeptides; glyceride derivatives of amino acids, oligopeptides, and polypeptides; lecithins and hydrogenated lecithins; lysolecithins and hydrogenated lysolecithins; phospholipids and derivatives thereof; lysophospholipids and derivatives thereof; carnitine fatty acid ester salts; salts of alkylsulfates; fatty acid salts; sodium docusate; acylactylates; mono- and di-acetylated tartaric acid esters of mono- and di-glycerides; succinylated mono- and di- glycerides; citric acid esters of mono- and di-glycer
  • ionic surfactants include, by way of example: lecithins, lysolecithin, phospholipids, lysophospholipids and derivatives thereof; carnitine fatty acid ester salts; salts of alkylsulfates; fatty acid salts; sodium docusate; acylactylates; mono- and di-acetylated tartaric acid esters of mono- and di-glycerides; succinylated mono- and di-glycerides; citric acid esters of mono- and di-glycerides; and mixtures thereof.
  • Ionic surfactants can be the ionized forms of lecithin, lysolecithin, phosphatidylcholine, phosphatidylethanolamine, phosphatidylglycerol, phosphatidic acid, phosphatidylserine, lysophosphatidylcholine, lysophosphatidylethanolamine, lysophosphatidylglycerol, lysophosphatidic acid, lysophosphatidylserine, PEG- phosphatidylethanolamine, PVP-phosphatidylethanolamine, lactylic esters of fatty acids, stearoyl-2-lactylate, stearoyl lactylate, succinylated monoglycerides, mono/diacetylated tartaric acid esters of mono/diglycerides, citric acid esters of mono/diglycerides, cholylsarcosine, caproate, capry
  • Hydrophilic non-ionic surfactants can include, but are not limited to, alkylglucosides; alkylmaltosides; alkylthioglucosides; lauryl macrogolglycerides; polyoxyalkylene alkyl ethers such as polyethylene glycol alkyl ethers; polyoxyalkylene alkylphenols such as polyethylene glycol alkyl phenols; polyoxyalkylene alkyl phenol fatty acid esters such as polyethylene glycol fatty acids monoesters and polyethylene glycol fatty acids diesters; polyethylene glycol glycerol fatty acid esters; polyglycerol fatty acid esters; polyoxyalkylene sorbitan fatty acid esters such as polyethylene glycol sorbitan fatty acid esters; hydrophilic transesterification products of a polyol with at least one member of glycerides, vegetable oils, hydrogenated vegetable oils, fatty acids, and sterols; polyoxyethylene sterols, derivatives
  • hydrophilic-non-ionic surfactants include, without limitation, PEG- 10 laurate, PEG- 12 laurate, PEG-20 laurate, PEG-32 laurate, PEG-32 dilaurate, PEG-12 oleate, PEG-15 oleate, PEG-20 oleate, PEG-20 dioleate, PEG-32 oleate, PEG-200 oleate, PEG-400 oleate, PEG-15 stearate, PEG-32 distearate, PEG-40 stearate, PEG-100 stearate, PEG-20 dilaurate, PEG-25 glyceryl trioleate, PEG-32 dioleate, PEG-20 glyceryl laurate, PEG-30 glyceryl laurate, PEG-20 glyceryl stearate, PEG-20 glyceryl oleate, PEG-30 glyceryl oleate, PEG-30 glyceryl o
  • Suitable lipophilic surfactants include, by way of example only: fatty alcohols; glycerol fatty acid esters; acetylated glycerol fatty acid esters; lower alcohol fatty acids esters; propylene glycol fatty acid esters; sorbitan fatty acid esters; polyethylene glycol sorbitan fatty acid esters; sterols and sterol derivatives; polyoxyethylated sterols and sterol derivatives; polyethylene glycol alkyl ethers; sugar esters; sugar ethers; lactic acid derivatives of mono- and di-glycerides; hydrophobic transesterification products of a polyol with at least one member of glycerides, vegetable oils, hydrogenated vegetable oils, fatty acids and sterols; oil-soluble vitamins/vitamin derivatives; and mixtures thereof.
  • non-limiting examples of lipophilic surfactants include glycerol fatty acid esters, propylene glycol fatty acid esters, and mixtures thereof, or are hydrophobic transesterification products of a polyol with at least one member of vegetable oils, hydrogenated vegetable oils, and triglycerides.
  • the pharmaceutical composition can include a solubilizer to ensure good solubilization and/or dissolution of a compound as provided herein and to minimize precipitation of the compound. This can be especially important for pharmaceutical compositions for non-oral use, e.g., pharmaceutical compositions for injection.
  • a solubilizer can also be added to increase the solubility of the hydrophilic drug and/or other components, such as surfactants, or to maintain the pharmaceutical composition as a stable or homogeneous solution or dispersion.
  • solubilizers include, but are not limited to, the following: alcohols and polyols, such as ethanol, isopropanol, butanol, benzyl alcohol, ethylene glycol, propylene glycol, butanediols and isomers thereof, glycerol, pentaerythritol, sorbitol, mannitol, transcutol, dimethyl isosorbide, polyethylene glycol, polypropylene glycol, polyvinylalcohol, hydroxypropyl methylcellulose and other cellulose derivatives, cyclodextrins and cyclodextrin derivatives; ethers of polyethylene glycols having an average molecular weight of about 200 to about 6000, such as tetrahydrofurfuryl alcohol PEG ether (glycofurol) or methoxy PEG; amides and other nitrogen- containing compounds such as 2-pyrrolidone, 2-piperidone,
  • solubilizers can also be used. Examples include, but not limited to, triacetin, triethylcitrate, ethyl oleate, ethyl caprylate, dimethylacetamide, N-methylpyrrolidone, N-hydroxyethylpyrrolidone, polyvinylpyrrolidone, hydroxypropyl methylcellulose, hydroxypropyl cyclodextrins, ethanol, polyethylene glycol 200-100, glycofurol, transcutol, propylene glycol, and dimethyl isosorbide.
  • solubilizers include sorbitol, glycerol, triacetin, ethyl alcohol, PEG-400, glycofurol and propylene glycol.
  • the amount of solubilizer that can be included is not particularly limited.
  • the amount of a given solubilizer can be limited to a bioacceptable amount, which can be readily determined by one of skill in the art.
  • the solubilizer can be in a weight ratio of about 10%, 25%, 50%, 100%, or up to about 200% by weight, based on the combined weight of the drug, and other excipients.
  • solubilizer can also be used, such as about 5%, 2%, 1% or even less.
  • solubilizer can be present in an amount of about 1% to about 100%o, more typically about 5% to about 25% by weight.
  • the pharmaceutical composition can further include one or more pharmaceutically acceptable additives and excipients.
  • additives and excipients include, without limitation, detackifiers, anti-foaming agents, buffering agents, polymers, antioxidants, preservatives, chelating agents, viscomodulators, tonicifiers, flavorants, colorants, oils, odorants, opacifiers, suspending agents, binders, fillers, plasticizers, lubricants, and mixtures thereof.
  • Exemplary preservatives can include antioxidants, chelating agents, antimicrobial preservatives, antifungal preservatives, alcohol preservatives, acidic preservatives, and other preservatives.
  • Exemplary antioxidants include, but are not limited to, alpha tocopherol, ascorbic acid, acorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole, butylated hydroxytoluene, monothioglycerol, potassium metabisulfite, propionic acid, propyl gallate, sodium ascorbate, sodium bisulfite, sodium metabisulfite, and sodium sulfite.
  • Exemplary chelating agents include ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid (EDTA), citric acid monohydrate, disodium edetate, dipotassium edetate, edetic acid, fumaric acid, malic acid, phosphoric acid, sodium edetate, tartaric acid, and trisodium edetate.
  • antimicrobial preservatives include, but are not limited to, benzalkonium chloride, benzethonium chloride, benzyl alcohol, bronopol, cetrimide, cetylpyridinium chloride, chlorhexidine, chlorobutanol, chlorocresol, chloroxylenol, cresol, ethyl alcohol, glycerin, hexetidine, imidurea, phenol, phenoxyethanol, phenylethyl alcohol, phenylmercuric nitrate, propylene glycol, and thimerosal.
  • Exemplary antifungal preservatives include, but are not limited to, butyl paraben, methyl paraben, ethyl paraben, propyl paraben, benzoic acid, hydroxybenzoic acid, potassium benzoate, potassium sorbate, sodium benzoate, sodium propionate, and sorbic acid.
  • Exemplary alcohol preservatives include, but are not limited to, ethanol, polyethylene glycol, phenol, phenolic compounds, bisphenol, chlorobutanol, hydroxybenzoate, and phenylethyl alcohol.
  • Exemplary acidic preservatives include, but are not limited to, vitamin A, vitamin C, vitamin E, beta-carotene, citric acid, acetic acid, dehydroacetic acid, ascorbic acid, sorbic acid, and phytic acid.
  • preservatives include, but are not limited to, tocopherol, tocopherol acetate, deteroxime mesylate, cetrimide, butylated hydroxyanisol (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluened (BHT), ethylenediamine, sodium lauryl sulfate (SLS), sodium lauryl ether sulfate (SLES), sodium bisulfite, sodium metabisulfite, potassium sulfite, potassium metabisulfite, Glydant Plus, Phenonip, methylparaben, Germall 115, Germaben II, Neolone, Kathon, and Euxyl.
  • the preservative is an anti-oxidant.
  • the preservative is a chelating agent.
  • oils include, but are not limited to, almond, apricot kernel, avocado, babassu, bergamot, black current seed, borage, cade, camomile, canola, caraway, carnauba, castor, cinnamon, cocoa butter, coconut, cod liver, coffee, corn, cotton seed, emu, eucalyptus, evening primrose, fish, flaxseed, geraniol, gourd, grape seed, hazel nut, hyssop, isopropyl myristate, jojoba, kukui nut, lavandin, lavender, lemon, litsea cubeba, macademia nut, mallow, mango seed, meadowfoam seed, mink, nutmeg, olive, orange, orange roughy, palm, palm kernel, peach kernel, peanut, poppy seed, pumpkin seed, rapeseed, rice bran, rosemary, safflower, sandalwood, sasquana
  • oils include, but are not limited to, butyl stearate, caprylic triglyceride, capric triglyceride, cyclomethicone, diethyl sebacate, dimethicone 360, isopropyl myristate, mineral oil, octyldodecanol, oleyl alcohol, silicone oil, and combinations thereof.
  • an acid or a base can be incorporated into the pharmaceutical composition to facilitate processing, to enhance stability, or for other reasons.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable bases include amino acids, amino acid esters, ammonium hydroxide, potassium hydroxide, sodium hydroxide, sodium hydrogen carbonate, aluminum hydroxide, calcium carbonate, magnesium hydroxide, magnesium aluminum silicate, synthetic aluminum silicate, synthetic hydrocalcite, magnesium aluminum hydroxide, diisopropylethylamine, ethanolamine, ethylenediamine, triethanolamine, triethylamine, triisopropanolamine, trimethylamine, tris(hydroxymethyl)aminomethane (TRIS) and the like.
  • bases that are salts of a pharmaceutically acceptable acid, such as acetic acid, acrylic acid, adipic acid, alginic acid, alkanesulfonic acid, amino acids, ascorbic acid, benzoic acid, boric acid, butyric acid, carbonic acid, citric acid, fatty acids, formic acid, fumaric acid, gluconic acid, hydroquinosulfonic acid, isoascorbic acid, lactic acid, maleic acid, oxalic acid, para-bromophenylsulfonic acid, propionic acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, salicylic acid, stearic acid, succinic acid, tannic acid, tartaric acid, thioglycolic acid, toluene sulfonic acid, uric acid, and the like.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable acid such as acetic acid, acrylic acid, adipic acid, alginic acid, alkanesulfonic acid, amino
  • Salts of polyprotic acids such as sodium phosphate, disodium hydrogen phosphate, and sodium dihydrogen phosphate can also be used.
  • the cation can be any convenient and pharmaceutically acceptable cation, such as ammonium, alkali metals, alkaline earth metals, and the like. Examples can include, but not limited to, sodium, potassium, lithium, magnesium, calcium and ammonium.
  • Suitable acids are pharmaceutically acceptable organic or inorganic acids.
  • suitable inorganic acids include hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, hydriodic acid, sulfuric acid, nitric acid, boric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like.
  • suitable organic acids include acetic acid, acrylic acid, adipic acid, alginic acid, alkanesulfonic acids, amino acids, ascorbic acid, benzoic acid, boric acid, butyric acid, carbonic acid, citric acid, fatty acids, formic acid, fumaric acid, gluconic acid, hydroquinosulfonic acid, isoascorbic acid, lactic acid, maleic acid, methane sulfonic acid, oxalic acid, para-bromophenylsulfonic acid, propionic acid, p- toluenesulfonic acid, salicylic acid, stearic acid, succinic acid, tannic acid, tartaric acid, thioglycolic acid, toluene sulfonic acid, uric acid and the like.
  • compositions for parenteral administration containing a compound as provided herein, and a pharmaceutical excipient suitable for parenteral administration.
  • pharmaceutical compositions for parenteral administration containing: (i) an effective amount of a disclosed compound; optionally (ii) an effective amount of one or more second agents; and (iii) one or more pharmaceutical excipients suitable for parenteral administration.
  • the pharmaceutical composition further contains: (iv) an effective amount of a third agent.
  • Aqueous solutions in saline are also conventionally used for injection.
  • Ethanol, glycerol, propylene glycol, liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like (and suitable mixtures thereof), cyclodextrin derivatives, and vegetable oils can also be employed.
  • Aqueous solutions in saline are also conventionally used for injection.
  • Ethanol, glycerol, propylene glycol, liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like (and suitable mixtures thereof), cyclodextrin derivatives, and vegetable oils can also be employed.
  • the proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating, such as lecithin, for the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion and by the use of surfactants.
  • the prevention of the action of microorganisms can be brought about by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like.
  • Sterile injectable solutions are prepared by incorporating a compound as provided herein in the required amount in the appropriate solvent with various other ingredients as enumerated above, as appropriate, followed by filtered sterilization.
  • dispersions are prepared by incorporating the various sterilized active ingredients into a sterile vehicle which contains the basic dispersion medium and the appropriate other ingredients from those enumerated above.
  • certain methods of preparation are vacuum-drying and freeze -drying techniques which yield a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
  • the injectable formulations can be sterilized, for example, by filtration through a bacterial- retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved or dispersed in sterile water or other sterile injectable medium prior to use.
  • Injectable compositions can contain from about 0.1 to about 5% w/w of a compound as disclosed herein.
  • compositions for topical (e.g., transdermal) administration containing a compound as provided herein, and a pharmaceutical excipient suitable for topical administration.
  • pharmaceutical compositions for topical administration containing: (i) an effective amount of a disclosed compound; optionally (ii) an effective amount of one or more second agents; and (iii) one or more pharmaceutical excipients suitable for topical administration.
  • the pharmaceutical composition further contains: (iv) an effective amount of a third agent.
  • compositions provided herein can be formulated into preparations in solid, semi-solid, or liquid forms suitable for local or topical administration, such as gels, water soluble jellies, creams, lotions, suspensions, foams, powders, slurries, ointments, solutions, oils, pastes, suppositories, sprays, emulsions, saline solutions, dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO)-based solutions.
  • DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
  • carriers with higher densities are capable of providing an area with a prolonged exposure to the active ingredients.
  • a solution formulation can provide more immediate exposure of the active ingredient to the chosen area.
  • compositions also can comprise suitable solid or gel phase carriers or excipients, which are compounds that allow increased penetration of, or assist in the delivery of, therapeutic molecules across the stratum corneum permeability barrier of the skin.
  • suitable solid or gel phase carriers or excipients which are compounds that allow increased penetration of, or assist in the delivery of, therapeutic molecules across the stratum corneum permeability barrier of the skin.
  • penetration- enhancing molecules known to those trained in the art of topical formulation.
  • humectants e.g., urea
  • glycols e.g., propylene glycol
  • alcohols e.g., ethanol
  • fatty acids e.g., oleic acid
  • surfactants e.g., isopropyl myristate and sodium lauryl sulfate
  • pyrrolidones e.g., isopropyl myristate and sodium lauryl sulfate
  • pyrrolidones e.glycerol monolaurate, sulfoxides, terpenes (e.g., menthol)
  • amines amides, alkanes, alkanols, water, calcium carbonate, calcium phosphate, various sugars, starches, cellulose derivatives, gelatin, and polymers such as polyethylene glycols.
  • Another exemplary formulation for use in the disclosed methods employs transdermal delivery devices ("patches").
  • transdermal patches can be
  • transdermal patches for the delivery of pharmaceutical agents is well known in the art. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,023,252, 4,992,445 and 5,001, 139. Such patches can be constructed for continuous, pulsatile, or on demand delivery of pharmaceutical agents.
  • Suitable devices for use in delivering intradermal pharmaceutically acceptable compositions described herein include short needle devices such as those described in U.S. Patents 4,886,499; 5,190,521 ; 5,328,483; 5,527,288; 4,270,537; 5,015,235; 5,141,496; and 5,417,662.
  • Intradermal compositions can be administered by devices which limit the effective penetration length of a needle into the skin, such as those described in PCT publication WO 99/34850 and functional equivalents thereof.
  • Jet injection devices which deliver liquid vaccines to the dermis via a liquid jet injector and/or via a needle which pierces the stratum corneum and produces a jet which reaches the dermis are suitable.
  • Jet injection devices are described, for example, in U.S. Patents 5,480,381 ; 5,599,302; 5,334,144; 5,993,412; 5,649,912; 5,569,189; 5,704,911 ; 5,383,851 ; 5,893,397; 5,466,220; 5,339,163; 5,312,335; 5,503,627; 5,064,413; 5,520,639; 4,596,556; 4,790,824; 4,941,880; 4,940,460; and PCT publications WO 97/37705 and WO 97/13537.
  • Ballistic powder/particle delivery devices which use compressed gas to accelerate vaccine in powder form through the outer layers of the skin to the dermis are suitable.
  • conventional syringes can be used in the classical mantoux method of intradermal administration.
  • Topically-administrable formulations can, for example, comprise from about 1% to about 10%
  • topically-administrable formulations can, for example, comprise from about 1% to about 9% (w/w) compound of formula (I), such as from about 1% to about 8% (w/w), further such as from about 1% to about 7% (w/w), further such as from about 1% to about 6% (w/w), further such as from about 1% to about 5% (w/w), further such as from about 1% to about 4% (w/w), further such as from about 1% to about 3% (w/w), and further such as from about 1% to about 2% (w/w) compound of formula (I).
  • Formulations for topical administration can further comprise one or more of the additional pharmaceutically acceptable excipients described herein.
  • compositions for inhalation administration containing a compound as provided herein, and a pharmaceutical excipient suitable for topical administration.
  • pharmaceutical compositions for inhalation administration containing: (i) an effective amount of a disclosed compound; optionally (ii) an effective amount of one or more second agents; and (iii) one or more pharmaceutical excipients suitable for inhalation administration.
  • the pharmaceutical composition further contains: (iv) an effective amount of a third agent.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions for inhalation or insufflation include solutions and suspensions in pharmaceutically acceptable, aqueous or organic solvents, or mixtures thereof, and powders.
  • the liquid or solid pharmaceutical compositions can contain suitable pharmaceutically acceptable excipients as described herein.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions are administered by the oral or nasal respiratory route for local or systemic effect.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions in pharmaceutically acceptable solvents can be nebulized by use of inert gases. Nebulized solutions can be inhaled directly from the nebulizing device or the nebulizing device can be attached to a face mask tent, or intermittent positive pressure breathing machine. Solution, suspension, or powder pharmaceutical compositions can be administered, e.g., orally or nasally, from devices that deliver the formulation in an appropriate manner.
  • the disclosure provides a pharmaceutical composition for treating ophthalmic disorders.
  • the pharmaceutical composition can contain an effective amount of a compound as provided herein and a pharmaceutical excipient suitable for ocular administration.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions suitable for ocular administration can be presented as discrete dosage forms, such as drops or sprays each containing a predetermined amount of an active ingredient a solution, or a suspension in an aqueous or non-aqueous liquid, an oil-in-water emulsion, or a water-in-oil liquid emulsion.
  • Other administration foms include intraocular injection, intravitreal injection, topically, or through the use of a drug eluting device, microcapsule, implant, or microfluidic device.
  • the compounds as provided herein are administered with a carrier or excipient that increases the intraocular penetrance of the compound such as an oil and water emulsion with colloid particles having an oily core surrounded by an interfacial film.
  • a carrier or excipient that increases the intraocular penetrance of the compound such as an oil and water emulsion with colloid particles having an oily core surrounded by an interfacial film.
  • all local routes to the eye can be used including topical, subconjunctival, periocular, retrobulbar, subtenon, intracameral, intravitreal, intraocular, subretinal, juxtascleral and suprachoroidal administration.
  • Systemic or parenteral administration can be feasible including, but not limited to intravenous, subcutaneous, and oral delivery.
  • An exemplary method of administration will be intravitreal or subtenon injection of solutions or suspensions, or intravitreal or subtenon placement of bioerodible or non-bioerodible devices, or by topical ocular administration of solutions or suspensions, or posterior juxtascleral administration of a gel or cream formulation.
  • Eye drops can be prepared by dissolving the active ingredient in a sterile aqueous solution such as physiological saline, buffering solution, etc., or by combining powder compositions to be dissolved before use.
  • Other vehicles can be chosen, as is known in the art, including, but not limited to: balance salt solution, saline solution, water soluble polyethers such as polyethyene glycol, polyvinyls, such as polyvinyl alcohol and povidone, cellulose derivatives such as methylcellulose and hydroxypropyl methylcellulose, petroleum derivatives such as mineral oil and white petrolatum, animal fats such as lanolin, polymers of acrylic acid such as carboxypolymethylene gel, vegetable fats such as peanut oil and polysaccharides such as dextrans, and glycosaminoglycans such as sodium hyaluronate.
  • additives ordinarily used in the eye drops can be added.
  • Such additives include isotonizing agents (e.g., sodium chloride, etc.), buffer agent (e.g., boric acid, sodium monohydrogen phosphate, sodium dihydrogen phosphate, etc.), preservatives (e.g., benzalkonium chloride, benzethonium chloride, chlorobutanol, etc.), thickeners (e.g., saccharide such as lactose, mannitol, maltose, etc.; e.g., hyaluronic acid or its salt such as sodium hyaluronate, potassium hyaluronate, etc.; e.g., mucopolysaccharide such as chondroitin sulfate, etc.; e.g., sodium polyacrylate, carboxyvinyl polymer, crosslinked polyacrylate, polyvinyl alcohol, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, methyl
  • the colloid particles include at least one cationic agent and at least one non-ionic sufactant such as a poloxamer, tyloxapol, a polysorbate, a polyoxyethylene castor oil derivative, a sorbitan ester, or a polyoxyl stearate.
  • the cationic agent is an alkylamine, a tertiary alkyl amine, a quarternary ammonium compound, a cationic lipid, an amino alcohol, a biguanidine salt, a cationic compound or a mixture thereof.
  • the cationic agent is a biguanidine salt such as chlorhexidine, polyaminopropyl biguanidine, phenformin, alkylbiguanidine, or a mixture thereof.
  • the quaternary ammonium compound is a benzalkonium halide, lauralkonium halide, cetrimide, hexadecyltrimethylammonium halide, tetradecyltrimethylammonium halide, dodecyltrimethylammonium halide, cetrimonium halide, benzethonium halide, behenalkonium halide, cetalkonium halide, cetethyldimonium halide, cetylpyridinium halide, benzododecinium halide, chlorallyl methenamine halide, rnyristylalkonium halide, stearalkonium halide or a mixture of two or more thereof.
  • cationic agent is a benzalkonium chloride, lauralkonium chloride, benzododecinium bromide, benzethenium chloride, hexadecyltrimethylammonium bromide, tetradecyltrimethylammonium bromide, dodecyltrimethylammonium bromide or a mixture of two or more thereof.
  • the oil phase is mineral oil and light mineral oil, medium chain triglycerides (MCT), coconut oil; hydrogenated oils comprising hydrogenated cottonseed oil, hydrogenated palm oil, hydrogenate castor oil or hydrogenated soybean oil; polyoxyethylene hydrogenated castor oil derivatives comprising poluoxyl-40 hydrogenated castor oil, polyoxyl-60 hydrogenated castor oil or polyoxyl- 100 hydrogenated castor oil.
  • MCT medium chain triglycerides
  • coconut oil hydrogenated oils comprising hydrogenated cottonseed oil, hydrogenated palm oil, hydrogenate castor oil or hydrogenated soybean oil
  • polyoxyethylene hydrogenated castor oil derivatives comprising poluoxyl-40 hydrogenated castor oil, polyoxyl-60 hydrogenated castor oil or polyoxyl- 100 hydrogenated castor oil.
  • compositions for controlled release administration containing a compound as provided herein, and a pharmaceutical excipient suitable for controlled release administration.
  • pharmaceutical compositions for controlled release administration containing: (i) an effective amount of a disclosed compound; optionally (ii) an effective amount of one or more second agents; and (iii) one or more pharmaceutical excipients suitable for controlled release administration.
  • the pharmaceutical composition further contains: (iv) an effective amount of a third agent.
  • Active agents such as the compounds provided herein can be administered by controlled release means or by delivery devices that are well known to those of ordinary skill in the art. Examples include, but are not limited to, those described in U.S. Patent Nos.: 3,845,770; 3,916,899; 3,536,809; 3,598,123; and 4,008,719; 5,674,533; 5,059,595; 5,591,767; 5,120,548; 5,073,543; 5,639,476; 5,354,556; 5,639,480; 5,733,566; 5,739,108; 5,891,474; 5,922,356; 5,972,891 ; 5,980,945; 5,993,855; 6,045,830; 6,087,324; 6,113,943; 6,197,350; 6,248,363; 6,264,970; 6,267,981 ; 6,376,461 ; 6,419,961 ; 6,589,548; 6,613,358; 6,6
  • Such dosage forms can be used to provide slow or controlled release of one or more active agents using, for example, hydropropylmethyl cellulose, other polymer matrices, gels, permeable membranes, osmotic systems, multilayer coatings, microparticles, liposomes, microspheres, or a combination thereof to provide the desired release profile in varying proportions.
  • Suitable controlled release formulations known to those of ordinary skill in the art, including those described herein, can be readily selected for use with the active agents provided herein.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions provided encompass single unit dosage forms suitable for oral administration such as, but not limited to, tablets, capsules, gelcaps, and caplets that are adapted for controlled release.
  • controlled release pharmaceutical products have a common goal of improving drug therapy over that achieved by their non controlled counterparts.
  • the use of a controlled release preparation in medical treatment is characterized by a minimum of drug substance being employed to cure or control the disease, disorder, or condition in a minimum amount of time.
  • Advantages of controlled release formulations include extended activity of the drug, reduced dosage frequency, and increased subject compliance.
  • controlled release formulations can be used to affect the time of onset of action or other characteristics, such as blood levels of the drug, and can thus affect the occurrence of side (e.g., adverse) effects.
  • controlled release formulations are designed to initially release an amount of a compound as provided herein that promptly produces the desired therapeutic effect, and gradually and continually release other amounts of the compound to maintain this level of therapeutic or prophylactic effect over an extended period of time.
  • the compound In order to maintain this constant level of the compound in the body, the compound should be released from the dosage form at a rate that will replace the amount of drug being metabolized and excreted from the body.
  • Controlled release of an active agent can be stimulated by various conditions including, but not limited to, pH, temperature, enzymes, water, or other physiological conditions or compounds.
  • the pharmaceutical composition can be administered using intravenous infusion, an implantable osmotic pump, a transdermal patch, liposomes, or other modes of administration.
  • a pump can be used ⁇ see, Sefton, CRC Crit. Ref. Biomed. Eng. 14:201 (1987); Buchwald et al, Surgery 88:507 (1980); Saudek et al, N. Engl. J. Med. 321 :574 (1989)).
  • polymeric materials can be used.
  • a controlled release system can be placed in a subject at an appropriate site determined by a practitioner of skill, i.e.
  • the one or more active agents can be dispersed in a solid inner matrix, e.g., polymethylmethacrylate, polybutylmethacrylate, plasticized or unplasticized polyvinylchloride, plasticized nylon, plasticized poly ethylene terephthalate, natural rubber, polyisoprene, polyisobutylene, polybutadiene, polyethylene, ethylene-vinylacetate copolymers, silicone rubbers, polydimethylsiloxanes, silicone carbonate copolymers, hydrophilic polymers such as hydrogels of esters of acrylic and methacrylic acid, collagen, cross-linked polyvinylalcohol and cross-linked partially hydrolyzed polyvinyl acetate, that is surrounded by an outer polymeric membrane, e.g., polyethylene, polypropylene, ethylene/propylene copolymers, ethylene/ethyl acrylate copolymers, ethylene/vinylacetate copolymers, silicone rubbers, polydimethyl siloxa
  • a compound described herein can be delivered in the form of pharmaceutically acceptable compositions which comprise a therapeutically effective amount of one or more compounds described herein and/or one or more additional therapeutic agents such as a chemotherapeutic, formulated together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients.
  • the compound described herein and the additional therapeutic agent are administered in separate pharmaceutical compositions and can (e.g., because of different physical and/or chemical characteristics) be administered by different routes (e.g., one therapeutic is administered orally, while the other is administered intravenously).
  • the compound described herein and the additional therapeutic agent can be administered separately, but via the same route (e.g., both orally or both intravenously).
  • the compound described herein and the additional therapeutic agent can be administered in the same pharmaceutical composition.
  • the selected dosage level will depend upon a variety of factors including, for example, the activity of the particular compound employed, the route of administration, the time of administration, the rate of excretion or metabolism of the particular compound being employed, the rate and extent of absorption, the duration of the treatment, other drugs, compounds and/or materials used in combination with the particular compound employed, the age, sex, weight, condition, general health and prior medical history of the patient being treated, and like factors well known in the medical arts.
  • a suitable daily dose of a compound described herein and/or a chemotherapeutic will be that amount of the compound which, in some embodiments, can be the lowest dose effective to produce a therapeutic effect. Such an effective dose will generally depend upon the factors described above.
  • doses of the compounds described herein for a patient when used for the indicated effects, will range from about 0.0001 mg to about 100 mg per day, or about 0.001 mg to about 100 mg per day, or about 0.01 mg to about 100 mg per day, or about 0.1 mg to about 100 mg per day, or about 0.0001 mg to about 500 mg per day, or about 0.001 mg to about 500 mg per day, or about 0.01 mg to 1000 mg, or about 0.01 mg to about 500 mg per day, or about 0.1 mg to about 500 mg per day, or about about 1 mg to 50 mg per day, or about 5 mg to 40 mg.
  • An exemplary dosage is about 10 to 30 mg per day.
  • a suitable dose would be about 0.05 to about 7 g/day, such as about 0.05 to about 2.5 g/day.
  • Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions described herein can be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active ingredient which is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular patient, composition, and mode of administration, without being toxic to the patient.
  • dosage levels below the lower limit of the aforesaid range can be more than adequate, while in other cases still larger doses can be employed without causing any harmful side effect, e.g., by dividing such larger doses into several small doses for administration throughout the day.
  • the compounds can be administered daily, every other day, three times a week, twice a week, weekly, or bi-weekly.
  • the dosing schedule can include a "drug holiday," i.e. , the drug can be administered for two weeks on, one week off, or three weeks on, one week off, or four weeks on, one week off, etc., or continuously, without a drug holiday.
  • the compounds can be administered orally, intravenously, intraperitoneally, topically, transdermally, intramuscularly, subcutaneously, intranasally, sublingually, or by any other route.
  • a compound as provided herein is administered in multiple doses.
  • Dosing can be about once, twice, three times, four times, five times, six times, or more than six times per day. Dosing can be about once a month, about once every two weeks, about once a week, or about once every other day.
  • a compound as provided herein and another agent are administered together about once per day to about 6 times per day.
  • the administration of a compound as provided herein and an agent continues for less than about 7 days.
  • the administration continues for more than about 6, about 10, about 14, about 28 days, about two months, about six months, or about one year. In some cases, continuous dosing is achieved and maintained as long as necessary.
  • an agent as provided herein is administered for more than about 1, about 2, about 3, about 4, about 5, about 6, about 7, about 14, or about 28 days. In some embodiments, an agent as provided herein is administered for less than about 28, about 14, about 7, about 6, about 5, about 4, about 3, about 2, or about 1 day. In some embodiments, an agent as provided herein is administered chronically on an ongoing basis, e.g., for the treatment of chronic effects.
  • the doses of each agent or therapy can be lower than the corresponding dose for single-agent therapy.
  • the dose for single-agent therapy can range from, for example, about 0.0001 to about 200 mg, or about 0.001 to about 100 mg, or about 0.01 to about 100 mg, or about 0.1 to about 100 mg, or about 1 to about 50 mg per kilogram of body weight per day.
  • kits can include a compound or pharmaceutical composition as described herein, in suitable packaging, and written material that can include instructions for use, discussion of clinical studies, listing of side effects, and the like.
  • kits can also include information, such as scientific literature references, package insert materials, clinical trial results, and/or summaries of these and the like, which indicate or establish the activities and/or advantages of the pharmaceutical composition, and/or which describe dosing, administration, side effects, drug interactions, or other information useful to the health care provider.
  • information can be based on the results of various studies, for example, studies using experimental animals involving in vivo models and studies based on human clinical trials.
  • a memory aid is provided with the kit, e.g., in the form of numbers next to the tablets or capsules whereby the numbers correspond with the days of the regimen which the tablets or capsules so specified should be ingested.
  • a memory aid is a calendar printed on the card, e.g., as follows "First Week, Monday, Tuesday, . . . etc. . . . Second Week, Monday, Tuesday, . . . " etc.
  • a “daily dose” can be a single tablet or capsule or several tablets or capsules to be taken on a given day.
  • kits can further contain another agent.
  • the compound as provided herein and the agent are provided as separate pharmaceutical compositions in separate containers within the kit.
  • the compound as provided herein and the agent are provided as a single pharmaceutical composition within a container in the kit.
  • Suitable packaging and additional articles for use e.g., measuring cup for liquid preparations, foil wrapping to minimize exposure to air, and the like
  • kits can further comprise devices that are used to administer the active agents. Examples of such devices include, but are not limited to, syringes, drip bags, patches, and inhalers. Kits described herein can be provided, marketed and/or promoted to health providers, including physicians, nurses, pharmacists, formulary officials, and the like. Kits can also, in some embodiments, be marketed directly to the consumer.
  • Blister packs are well known in the packaging industry and are being widely used for the packaging of pharmaceutical unit dosage forms (tablets, capsules, and the like). Blister packs generally consist of a sheet of relatively stiff material covered with a foil of a preferably transparent plastic material. During the packaging process, recesses are formed in the plastic foil. The recesses have the size and shape of the tablets or capsules to be packed. Next, the tablets or capsules are placed in the recesses and the sheet of relatively stiff material is sealed against the plastic foil at the face of the foil which is opposite from the direction in which the recesses were formed. As a result, the tablets or capsules are sealed in the recesses between the plastic foil and the sheet. The strength of the sheet is such that the tablets or capsules can be removed from the blister pack by manually applying pressure on the recesses whereby an opening is formed in the sheet at the place of the recess. The tablet or capsule can then be removed via said opening.
  • Kits can further comprise pharmaceutically acceptable vehicles that can be used to administer one or more active agents.
  • the kit can comprise a sealed container of a suitable vehicle in which the active agent can be dissolved to form a particulate-free sterile solution that is suitable for parenteral administration.
  • Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable vehicles include, but are not limited to: Water for Injection USP; aqueous vehicles such as, but not limited to, Sodium Chloride Injection, Ringer's Injection, Dextrose Injection, Dextrose and Sodium Chloride Injection, and Lactated Ringer's Injection; water-miscible vehicles such as, but not limited to, ethyl alcohol, polyethylene glycol, and polypropylene glycol; and non-aqueous vehicles such as, but not limited to, corn oil, cottonseed oil, peanut oil, sesame oil, ethyl oleate, isopropyl myristate, and benzyl benzoate.
  • aqueous vehicles such as, but not limited to, Sodium Chloride Injection, Ringer's Injection, Dextrose Injection, Dextrose and Sodium Chloride Injection, and Lactated Ringer's Injection
  • water-miscible vehicles such as, but not limited to, ethyl alcohol
  • the present disclosure further encompasses anhydrous pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms comprising an active ingredient, since water can facilitate the degradation of some compounds.
  • water can be added (e.g., about 5%) in the pharmaceutical arts as a means of simulating long-term storage in order to determine characteristics such as shelf-life or the stability of formulations over time.
  • Anhydrous pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms can be prepared using anhydrous or low moisture containing ingredients and low moisture or low humidity conditions.
  • pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms which contain lactose can be made anhydrous if substantial contact with moisture and/or humidity during manufacturing, packaging, and/or storage is expected.
  • An anhydrous pharmaceutical composition can be prepared and stored such that its anhydrous nature is maintained.
  • anhydrous pharmaceutical compositions can be packaged using materials known to prevent exposure to water such that they can be included in suitable formulary kits.
  • suitable packaging include, but are not limited to, hermetically sealed foils, plastic or the like, unit dose containers, blister packs, and strip packs.
  • Phosphoinositide 3-kinases are members of a conserved family of lipid kinases that regulate numerous cell functions, including proliferation, differentiation, cell survival and metabolism.
  • PI3Ks Phosphoinositide 3-kinases
  • Class IA subgroup e.g., ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇
  • RTKs receptor tyrosine kinases
  • Class IB e.g. , ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇
  • GPCRs G-protein coupled receptors
  • PI3Ks exert their biological activities via a "PI3K-mediated signaling pathway" that includes several components that directly and/or indirectly transduce a signal triggered by a PI3K, including the generation of second messenger phophotidylinositol, 3, 4, 5 -triphosphate (PIP3) at the plasma membrane, activation of heterotrimeric G protein signaling, and generation of further second messengers such as cAMP, DAG, and IP3, all of which leads to an extensive cascade of protein kinase activation (reviewed in Vanhaesebroeck, B. et al. (2001) Annu Rev Biochem. 70:535-602).
  • PI3K-6 is activated by cellular receptors through interaction between the PI3K regulatory subunit (p85) SH2 domains, or through direct interaction with RAS.
  • PIP3 produced by PI3K activates effector pathways downstream through interaction with plextrin homology (PH) domain containing enzymes (e.g. , PDK-1 and AKT [PKB]).
  • PH plextrin homology
  • PI3K- ⁇ is not associated with a regulatory subunit of the p85 family, but rather with a regulatory subunit in the plOl family.
  • ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ is associated with GPCRs, and is responsible for the very rapid induction of PIP3.
  • ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ can be also activated by RAS.
  • provided herein are methods of modulating a PI3K kinase activity (e.g. , selectively modulating) by contacting the kinase with an effective amount of a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein.
  • Modulation can be inhibition (e.g., reduction) or activation (e.g., enhancement) of kinase activity.
  • provided herein are methods of inhibiting kinase activity by contacting the kinase with an effective amount of a compound as provided herein in solution.
  • provided herein are methods of inhibiting the kinase activity by contacting a cell, tissue, organ that express the kinase of interest with a compound provided herein.
  • methods of inhibiting kinase activity in a subject by administering into the subject an effective amount of a compound as provided herein.
  • the kinase activity is inhibited (e.g., reduced) by more than about 25%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, or 90% when contacted with a compound provided herein as compared to the kinase activity without such contact.
  • provided herein are methods of inhibiting PI3 kinase activity in a subject (including mammals such as humans) by contacting said subject with an amount of a compound as provided herein sufficient to inhibit or reduce the activity of the PI3 kinase in said subject.
  • the kinase is a lipid kinase or a protein kinase.
  • the kinase is selected from a PI3 kinase including different isoforms such as PI3 kinase ⁇ , PI3 kinase ⁇ , PI3 kinase ⁇ , PI3 kinase ⁇ ; DNA-PK; mTor; Abl, VEGFR, Ephrin receptor B4 (EphB4); TEK receptor tyrosine kinase (TIE2); FMS-related tyrosine kinase 3 (FLT-3); Platelet derived growth factor receptor (PDGFR); RET; ATM; ATR; hSmg- 1 ; Hck; Src; Epidermal growth factor receptor (EGFR); KIT; Inulsin Receptor (IR); and IGFR.
  • PI3 kinase including different isoforms such as PI3
  • PI3K-mediated disorder refers to a disease or condition involving aberrant
  • PI3K-mediated signaling pathway In one embodiment, provided herein is a method of treating a PI3K mediated disorder in a subject, the method comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or a pharmaceutical composition as provided herein. In some embodiments, provided herein is a method of treating a PI3K-6 or ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ mediated disorder in a subject, the method comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or a pharmaceutical composition as provided herein.
  • PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ are provided herein.
  • the method comprising contacting a cell expressing PI3K in vitro or in vivo with an effective amount of the compound or composition provided herein.
  • PI3Ks have been associated with a wide range of conditions, including immunity, cancer and thrombosis (reviewed in Vanhaesebroeck, B. et al. (2010) Current Topics in Microbiology and Immunology, DOI 10.1007/82_2010_65).
  • Class I PI3Ks particularly ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ and PI3K-6 isoforms, are highly expressed in leukocytes and have been associated with adaptive and innate immunity; thus, these PI3Ks are believed to be important mediators in inflammatory disorders and hematologic malignancies (reviewed in Harris, SJ et al. (2009) Curr Opin Investig Drugs 10(l l): 1151-62); Rommel C. et al. (2007) Nat Rev Immunol 7(3): 191-201 ; Durand CA et al. (2009) J Immunol. 183(9):5673-84; Dil N, Marshall AJ. (2009) Mol Immunol.
  • PI3K-6 is an important mediator of B-cell receptor (BCR) signaling, and is upstream of AKT, calcium flux, PLCy, MAP kinase, P70S6k, and FOX03a activation.
  • BCR B-cell receptor
  • PI3K-6 is also important in IL4R, SIP, and CXCR5 signaling, and has been shown to modulate responses to toll-like receptors 4 and 9.
  • Inhibitors of PI3K- ⁇ have shown the importance of PI3K-6 in B-cell development (Marginal zone and Bl cells), B-cell activation, chemotaxis, migration and homing to lymphoid tissue, and in the control of immunoglobulin class switching leading to the production of IgE.
  • PI3K-6 has been demonstrated to have a role in T-cell receptor and cytokine signaling, and is upstream of AKT, PLCy, and GSK3b.
  • T-cell defects including proliferation, activation, and differentiation have been observed, leading to reduced T helper cell 2 (TH2) response, memory T-cell specific defects (DTH reduction), defects in antigen dependent cellular trafficking, and defects in chemotaxis/migration to chemokines (e.g. , SIP, CCR7, CD62L).
  • chemokines e.g. , SIP, CCR7, CD62L.
  • PI3K-6 In neutrophils, PI3K-6 along with ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ , and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ , contribute to the responses to immune complexes, FCyRII signaling, including migration and neutrophil respiratory burst.
  • Human neutrophils undergo rapid induction of PIP3 in response to formyl peptide receptor (FMLP) or complement component C5a (C5a) in a ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ dependent manner, followed by a longer PIP3 production period that is PI3K-6 dependent, and is essential for respiratory burst.
  • the response to immune complexes is contributed by PI3K-6, ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ , and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ , and is an important mediator of tissue damage in models of autoimmune disease (Randis TM et al.
  • mice were highly protected in an FcyR-dependent model of autoantibody- induced skin blistering and partially protected in an FcyR-dependent model of inflammatory arthritis, whereas combined deficiency of ⁇ 3 ⁇ and PI3K6 resulted in near complete protection in inflammatory arthritis. (Id.).
  • glucocorticoid responsiveness can be restored by treatment of the cells with inhibitors of PI3K-6.
  • Macrophages also rely on PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ for responses to immune complexes through the arthus reaction (FCgR and C5a signaling) (Randis TM, et al. (2008) Eur J Immunol. 38(5): 1215-24 ; Marwick JA et al. (2009) Am J Respir Crit Care Med. 179(7):542-8; Konrad S, et al. (2008) J Biol Chem. 283(48):33296-303).
  • Natural killer (NK) cells are dependent on both PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ for efficient migration towards chemokines including CXCL10, CCL3, SIP and CXCL12, or in response to LPS in the peritoneum (Guo H, et al. (2008) J Exp Med. 205(10):2419-35; Tassi I, et al. (2007) Immunity 27(2):214-27; Saudemont A, (2009) Proc Natl Acad Sci USA. 106(14):5795-800; Kim N, et al. (2007) Blood 110(9):3202-8).
  • PI3K-6, ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ , and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ in the differentiation, maintenance, and activation of immune cells support a role for these enzymes in inflammatory disorders ranging from autoimmune diseases (e.g. , rheumatoid arthritis, multiple sclerosis) to allergic inflammatory disorders, such as asthma, and inflammatory respiratory disease such as COPD. Extensive evidence is available in experimental animal models, or can be evaluated using art-recognized animal models.
  • described herein is a method of treating inflammatory disorders ranging from autoimmune diseases (e.g. , rheumatoid arthritis, multiple sclerosis) to allergic inflammatory disorders, such as asthma and COPD using a compound described herein.
  • PI3K-6 and/or - ⁇ have been shown to have anti-inflammatory activity in several autoimmune animal models for rheumatoid arthritis (Williams, O. et al. (2010) Chem Biol, 17(2): 123-34; WO 2009/088986; WO2009/088880; WO 2011/008302).
  • PI3K-6 is expressed in the RA synovial tissue (especially in the synovial lining which contains fibroblast-like synoviocytes (FLS), and selective PI3K-6 inhibitors have been shown to be effective in inhibiting synoviocyte growth and survival (Bartok et al. (2010) Arthritis Rheum 62 Suppl 10:362).
  • PI3K-6 and - ⁇ inhibitors have been shown to ameliorate arthritic symptoms (e.g. , swelling of joints, reduction of serum-induced collagen levels, reduction of joint pathology and/or inflammation), in art- recognized models for RA, such as collagen-induced arthritis and adjuvant induced arthritis (WO 2009/088986; WO2009/088880; WO 2011/008302).
  • SLE Systemic lupus erythematosus
  • T-cells T-cells, B-cell polyclonal expansion and differentiation into plasma cells, and the innate immune reasponse to endogenous damage associated molecular pattern molecules (DAMPS), and the inflammatory responses to immune complexes through the complement system as well as the F c receptors.
  • DAMPS damage associated molecular pattern molecules
  • the role of PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ together in these pathways and cell types suggest that blockade with an inhibitor would be effective in these diseases.
  • a role for PI3K in lupus is also predicted by two genetic models of lupus. The deletion of phosphatase and tensin homolog (PTEN) leads to a lupus-like phenotype, as does a transgenic activation of ClasslA PI3Ks, which includes PI3K-6.
  • PTEN phosphatase and tensin homolog
  • PI3K-6 has been shown by genetic models and by inhibitor treatment to be essential for mast-cell activation in a passive cutaneous anaphalaxis assay (Ali K et al. (2008) J Immunol. 180(4):2538-44; Ali K, (2004) Nature 431(7011): 1007-11).
  • a PI3K-6 knockout is resistant, showing a defect in macrophage activation and C5a production.
  • Knockout studies and studies with inhibitors for both PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ support a role for both of these enzymes in the ovalbumin induced allergic airway inflammation and hyper-responsiveness model (Lee KS et al.
  • PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ inhibition can be used in treating COPD.
  • COPD COPD-induced PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ inhibition
  • the PI3K-6 knockout does not develop smoke induced glucocorticoid resistance, while wild-type and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ knockout mice do.
  • An inhaled formulation of dual PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ inhibitor blocked inflammation in a LPS or smoke COPD models as measured by neutrophilia and glucocorticoid resistance (Doukas J, et al. (2009,) J Pharmacol Exp Ther. 328(3):758-65).
  • Class I PI3Ks particularly PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ isoforms, are also associated with cancers
  • Types of cancer that can be treated with an inhibitor of PI3K include, e.g., leukemia, chronic lymphocytic leukemia, acute myeloid leukemia, chronic myeloid leukemia (e.g., Salmena, L et al. (2008) Cell 133:403-414; Chapuis, N et al. (2010) Clin Cancer Res. 16(22):5424-35; Khwaja, A (2010) Curr Top Microbiol Immunol. 347: 169-88); lymphoma, e.g. , non-Hodgkin's lymphoma (e.g., Salmena, L et al.
  • lung cancer e.g. , non-small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer (e.g., Herrera, VA et al. (2011) Anticancer Res. 31(3):849-54); melanoma (e.g. , Haluska, F et al. (2007) Semin Oncol. 34(6):546-54); prostate cancer (e.g. , Sarker, D et al. (2009) Clin Cancer Res. 15(15):4799-805); glioblastoma (e.g., Chen, JS et al. (2008) Mol Cancer Ther. 7:841-850); endometrial cancer (e.g. , Bansal, N et al.
  • endometrial cancer e.g. , Bansal, N et al.
  • pancreatic cancer e.g., Furukawa, T (2008) J Gastroenterol. 43(12):905-11
  • renal cell carcinoma e.g., Porta, C and Figlin, RA (2009) J Urol. 182(6):2569-77
  • colorectal cancer e.g., Saif, MW and Chu, E (2010) Cancer J. 16(3): 196-201
  • breast cancer e.g., Torbett, NE et al. (2008) Biochem J. 415:97-100
  • thyroid cancer e.g., Brzezianska, E and Pastuszak-Lewandoska, D (2011) Front Biosci. 16:422-39
  • ovarian cancer e.g. , Mazzoletti, M and Broggini, M (2010) Curr Med Chem. 17(36):4433-47.
  • PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ are highly expressed in the heme compartment, and some solid tumors, including prostate, breast and glioblastomas (Chen J.S. et al. (2008) Mol Cancer Ther. 7(4):841-50; Ikeda H. et al. (2010) Blood 116(9): 1460-8).
  • AML acute myeloid leukemia
  • MM multiple myeloma
  • CLL chronic lymphocytic leukemia
  • hematological cancers including, but not limited to acute myeloid leukemia (AML), multiple myeloma (MM), and chronic lymphocytic leukemia (CLL).
  • AML acute myeloid leukemia
  • MM multiple myeloma
  • CLL chronic lymphocytic leukemia
  • a PI3K-6 inhibitor (CAL-101) has been evaluated in a phase 1 trial in patients with haematological malignancies, and showed activity in CLL in patients with poor prognostic characteristics.
  • inhibition of PI3K-6 not only affects tumor cells directly, but it also affects the ability of the tumor cells to interact with their microenvironment.
  • This microenvironment includes contact with and factors from stromal cells, T-cells, nurse like cells, as well as other tumor cells.
  • CAL-101 suppresses the expression of stromal and T-cell derived factors including CCL3, CCL4, and CXCL13, as well as the CLL tumor cells' ability to respond to these factors.
  • CAL-101 treatment in CLL patients induces rapid lymph node reduction and redistribution of lymphocytes into the circulation, and affects tonic survival signals through the BCR, leading to reduced cell viability, and an increase in apoptosis.
  • Single agent CAL-101 treatment was also active in mantle cell lymphoma and refractory non Hodgkin's lymphoma (Furman, RR, et al. 52 nd Annual ASH Meeting and Exposition; 2010 Dec 4-7; Orlando, FL; Hoellenriegel, J, et al. 52 nd Annual ASH Meeting and Exposition; 2010 Dec 4-7; Orlando, FL; Webb, HK, et al.
  • PI3K-6 inhibitors have shown activity against PI3K-6 positive gliomas in vitro (Kashishian A, et al. Poster presented at: The American Association of Cancer Research 102 nd Annual Meeting; 2011 Apr 2-6; Orlando, FL).
  • PI3K-6 is the PI3K isoform that is most commonly activated in tumors where the PTEN tumor suppressor is mutated (Ward S, et al. (2003) Chem Biol. 10(3):207-13). In this subset of tumors, treatment with the PI3K-6 inhibitor either alone or in combination with a cytotoxic agent can be effective.
  • PI3K-6 inhibitors Another mechanism for PI3K-6 inhibitors to have an affect in solid tumors involves the tumor cells' interaction with their micro-environment. PI3K-6, ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ , and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ are expressed in the immune cells that infiltrate tumors, including tumor infiltrating lymphocytes, macrophages, and neutrophils. PI3K-6 inhibitors can modify the function of these tumor-associated immune cells and how they respond to signals from the stroma, the tumor, and each other, and in this way affect tumor cells and metastasis (Hoellenriegel, J, et al. 52 nd Annual ASH Meeting and Exposition; 2010 Dec 4-7; Orlando, FL).
  • PI3K-6 is also expressed in endothelial cells. It has been shown that tumors in mice treated with PI3K-6 selective inhibitors are killed more readily by radiation therapy. In this same study, capillary network formation is impaired by the PI3K inhibitor, and it is postulated that this defect contributes to the greater killing with radiation.
  • PI3K-6 inhibitors can affect the way in which tumors interact with their microenviroment, including stromal cells, immune cells, and endothelial cells and be therapeutic either on its own or in conjunction with another therapy (Meadows, SA, et al. Paper presented at: 52 nd Annual ASH Meeting and Exposition; 2010 Dec 4-7; Orlando, FL; Geng L, et al. (2004) Cancer Res. 64(14):4893-9).
  • inhibition of PI3K can be used to treat a neuropsychiatric disorder, e.g. , an autoimmune brain disorder.
  • a neuropsychiatric disorder e.g. , an autoimmune brain disorder.
  • Infectious and immune factors have been implicated in the pathogenesis of several neuropsychiatric disorders, including, but not limited to, Sydenham's chorea (SC) (Garvey, M.A. et al. (2005) J. Child Neurol. 20:424-429), Tourette's syndrome (TS), obsessive compulsive disorder (OCD) (Asbahr, F.R. et al. (1998) Am. J.
  • SC Sydenham's chorea
  • TS Tourette's syndrome
  • OCD obsessive compulsive disorder
  • AD/HD attention deficit/hyperactivity disorder
  • PANDAS disorders provide an example of disorders where the onset and exacerbation of neuropsychiatric symptoms is preceded by a streptococcal infection (Kurlan, R., Kaplan, E.L. (2004) Pediatrics 113:883-886; Garvey, M.A. et al. (1998) ./ Clin. Neurol. 13:413-423). Many of the PANDAS disorders share a common mechanism of action resulting from antibody responses against streptococcal associated epitopes, such as GlcNAc, which produces neurological effects (Kirvan. C.A. et al. (2006) J.
  • a method of treating e.g. , reducing or ameliorating one or more symptoms of) a neuropsychiatric disorder, (e.g., an autoimmune brain disorder), using a PI3K-5 and/or - ⁇ inhibitor is described, alone or in combination therapy.
  • a neuropsychiatric disorder e.g., an autoimmune brain disorder
  • one or more PI3K-5 and/or - ⁇ inhibitors described herein can be used alone or in combination with any suitable therapeutic agent and/or modalities, e.g., dietary supplement, for treatment of neuropsychiatric disorders.
  • Exemplary neuropsychiatric disorders that can be treated with the PI3K-5 and/or - ⁇ inhibitors described herein include, but are not limited to, PANDAS disorders,
  • PDD Pervasive Developmental Disorder
  • CDD Childhood Disintegrative Disorder
  • PDD-NOS PDD-Not Otherwise Specified
  • Animal models for evaluating the activity of the PI3K-5 and/or - ⁇ inhibitor are known in the art. For example, a mouse model of PANDAS disorders is described in, e.g., Yaddanapudi, K. et al. (2010) supra; and Hoffman, K.I. et al.
  • provided herein are methods of using the compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein to treat disease conditions, including, but not limited to, diseases associated with malfunctioning of one or more types of PI3 kinase.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • the disclosure relates to a method of treating a hyperproliferative disorder in a subject that comprises administering to said subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • said method relates to the treatment of cancer such as acute myeloid leukemia, thymus, brain, lung, squamous cell, skin, eye, retinoblastoma, intraocular melanoma, oral cavity and oropharyngeal, bladder, gastric, stomach, pancreatic, bladder, breast, cervical, head, neck, renal, kidney, liver, ovarian, prostate, colorectal, esophageal, testicular, gynecological, thyroid, CNS, PNS, AIDS-related (e.g., Lymphoma and Kaposi's Sarcoma) or viral-induced cancer.
  • cancer such as acute myeloid leukemia, thymus, brain, lung, squamous cell, skin, eye, retinoblastoma, intraocular melanoma, oral cavity and oropharyngeal, bladder, gastric, stomach, pancreatic, bladder, breast, cervical, head, neck, renal, kidney, liver, ovarian, prostate
  • said method relates to the treatment of a non-cancerous hyperproli erarive disorder such as benign hyperplasia of the skin (e. g., psoriasis), restenosis, or prostate (e. g., benign prostatic hypertrophy (BPH)).
  • a non-cancerous hyperproli erarive disorder such as benign hyperplasia of the skin (e. g., psoriasis), restenosis, or prostate (e. g., benign prostatic hypertrophy (BPH)).
  • Patients that can be treated with compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, according to the methods as provided herein include, for example, but not limited to, patients that have been diagnosed as having psoriasis; restenosis; atherosclerosis; BPH; breast cancer such as a ductal carcinoma in duct tissue in a mammary gland, medullary carcinomas, colloid carcinomas, tubular carcinomas, and inflammatory breast cancer; ovarian cancer, including epithelial ovarian tumors such as adenocarcinoma in the ovary and an adenocarcinoma that has migrated from the ovary into the abdominal cavity; uterine cancer; cervical cancer such as adenocarcinoma in the cervix epithelial including squamous cell carcinoma and adenocar
  • blastic plasmacytoid dendritic cell neoplasm acute myelogenous leukemia (AML), chronic myelogenous leukemia (CML), mastocytosis, chronic lymphocytic leukemia (CLL), multiple myeloma (MM), and myelodysplasia syndrome (MDS); bone cancer; lung cancer such as non-small cell lung cancer (NSCLC), which is divided into squamous cell carcinomas, adenocarcinomas, and large cell undifferentiated carcinomas, and small cell lung cancer; skin cancer such as basal cell carcinoma, melanoma, squamous cell carcinoma and actinic keratosis, which is a skin condition that sometimes develops into squamous cell carcinoma; eye retinoblastoma; cutaneous or intraocular (eye) melanoma; primary liver cancer (cancer that begins in the liver); kidney cancer; thyroid cancer such as papillary, follicular, medullary and ana
  • central nervous system cancers such as primary brain tumor, which includes gliomas (astrocytoma, anaplastic astrocytoma, or glioblastoma multiforme), Oligodendroglioma, Ependymoma, Meningioma, Lymphoma, Schwannoma, and Medulloblastoma; peripheral nervous system (PNS) cancers such as acoustic neuromas and malignant peripheral nerve sheath tumor (MPNST) including neurofibromas and schwannomas
  • a method of treating an inflammation disorder including autoimmune diseases in a subject.
  • the method comprises administering to said subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • autoimmune diseases includes but is not limited to acute disseminated encephalomyelitis (ADEM), Addison's disease, antiphospholipid antibody syndrome (APS), aplastic anemia, autoimmune hepatitis, autoimmune skin disease, coeliac disease, Crohn's disease, Diabetes mellitus (type 1), Goodpasture's syndrome, Graves' disease, Guillain-Barre syndrome (GBS), Hashimoto's disease, lupus erythematosus, multiple sclerosis, myasthenia gravis, opsoclonus myoclonus syndrome (OMS), optic neuritis, Ord's thyroiditis, oemphigus, polyarthritis, primary biliary cirrhosis, psoriasis, rheumatoid arthritis, Reiter's syndrome, Takayasu's arteritis, temporal arteritis (also known as "giant cell arteritis”), warm autoimmune hemolytic an
  • inflammatory alopecia Chagas disease, chronic fatigue syndrome, dysautonomia, endometriosis, hidradenitis suppurativa, interstitial cystitis, neuromyotonia, sarcoidosis, scleroderma, ulcerative colitis, vitiligo, and vulvodynia.
  • Other disorders include bone -re sorption disorders and thrombosis.
  • Inflammation takes on many forms and includes, but is not limited to, acute, adhesive, atrophic, catarrhal, chronic, cirrhotic, diffuse, disseminated, exudative, fibrinous, fibrosing, focal, granulomatous, hyperplastic, hypertrophic, interstitial, metastatic, necrotic, obliterative, parenchymatous, plastic, productive, proliferous, pseudomembranous, purulent, sclerosing, seroplastic, serous, simple, specific, subacute, suppurative, toxic, traumatic, and/or ulcerative inflammation.
  • Exemplary inflammatory conditions include, but are not limited to, inflammation associated with acne, anemia (e.g., aplastic anemia, haemolytic autoimmune anaemia), asthma, arteritis (e.g., polyarteritis, temporal arteritis, periarteritis nodosa, Takayasu's arteritis), arthritis (e.g., crystalline arthritis, osteoarthritis, psoriatic arthritis, gout flare, gouty arthritis, reactive arthritis, rheumatoid arthritis and Reiter's arthritis), ankylosing spondylitis, amylosis, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, autoimmune diseases, allergies or allergic reactions, atherosclerosis, bronchitis, bursitis, chronic prostatitis, conjunctivitis, Chagas disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, cermatomyositis, diverticulitis, diabetes (e.g., type I diabetes me), aplastic
  • the inflammatory disorder is selected from arthritis (e.g., rheumatoid arthritis), inflammatory bowel disease, inflammatory bowel syndrome, asthma, psoriasis, endometriosis, interstitial cystitis and prostatistis.
  • the inflammatory condition is an acute inflammatory condition (e.g., for example, inflammation resulting from infection).
  • the inflammatory condition is a chronic inflammatory condition (e.g., conditions resulting from asthma, arthritis and inflammatory bowel disease).
  • the compounds can also be useful in treating inflammation associated with trauma and non-inflammatory myalgia.
  • Immune disorders such as auto-immune disorders, include, but are not limited to, arthritis
  • rheumatoid arthritis including rheumatoid arthritis, spondyloarthopathies, gouty arthritis, degenerative joint diseases such as osteoarthritis, systemic lupus erythematosus, Sjogren's syndrome, ankylosing spondylitis, undifferentiated spondylitis, Behcet's disease, haemolytic autoimmune anaemias, multiple sclerosis, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, amylosis, acute painful shoulder, psoriatic, and juvenile arthritis), asthma, atherosclerosis, osteoporosis, bronchitis, tendonitis, bursitis, skin condition (e.g., psoriasis, eczema, burns, dermatitis, pruritus (itch)), enuresis, eosinophilic disease, gastrointestinal disorder (e.g., selected from peptic ulcers, regional enteritis, diverticulitis, gastrointestinal bleeding
  • relapsing polychondritis e.g., atrophic polychondritis and systemic polychondromalacia
  • a gastroprokinetic agent e.g., ileus, postoperative ileus and ileus during sepsis; gastroesophageal reflux disease (GORD, or its synonym GERD
  • GORD gastroesophageal reflux disease
  • GERD gastroesophageal reflux disease
  • GERD gastroesophageal reflux disease
  • eosinophilic esophagitis gastroparesis such as diabetic gastroparesis
  • food intolerances and food allergies and other functional bowel disorders such as nonulcerative dyspepsia (NUD) and non-cardiac chest pain (NCCP, including costo-chondritis)
  • a method of treating inflammatory or autoimmune diseases comprising administering to a subject (e.g., a mammal) a therapeutically effective amount of a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, that selectively inhibit PI3K-6 and/or ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ as compared to all other type I PI3 kinases.
  • a subject e.g., a mammal
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • Such selective inhibition of PI3K-6 and/or ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ can be advantageous for treating any of the diseases or conditions described herein.
  • selective inhibition of PI3K-6 can inhibit inflammatory responses associated with inflammatory diseases, autoimmune disease, or diseases related to an undesirable immune response including, but not limited to asthma, emphysema, allergy, dermatitis, rheumatoid arthritis, psoriasis, lupus erythematosus, anaphylaxsis, or graft versus host disease.
  • Selective inhibition of PI3K-6 can further provide for a reduction in the inflammatory or undesirable immune response without a concomittant reduction in the ability to reduce a bacterial, viral, and/or fungal infection.
  • Selective inhibition of both PI3K-6 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ can be advantageous for inhibiting the inflammatory response in the subject to a greater degree than that would be provided for by inhibitors that selectively inhibit PI3K - ⁇ or ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ alone.
  • one or more of the subject methods are effective in reducing antigen specific antibody production in vivo by about 2-fold, 3-fold, 4-fold, 5-fold, 7.5-fold, 10-fold, 25-fold, 50-fold, 100-fold, 250-fold, 500-fold, 750-fold, or about 1000-fold or more.
  • one or more of the subject methods are effective in reducing antigen specific IgG3 and/or IgGM production in vivo by about 2-fold, 3-fold, 4-fold, 5-fold, 7.5-fold, 10-fold, 25-fold, 50-fold, 100-fold, 250-fold, 500-fold, 750-fold, or about 1000-fold or more.
  • one of more of the subject methods are effective in ameliorating symptoms associated with rheumatoid arthritis including, but not limited to a reduction in the swelling of joints, a reduction in serum anti-collagen levels, and/or a reduction in joint pathology such as bone resorption, cartilage damage, pannus, and/or inflammation.
  • the subject methods are effective in reducing ankle inflammation by at least about 2%, 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 50%, 60%, or about 75% to 90%.
  • the subject methods are effective in reducing knee inflammation by at least about 2%, 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 50%, 60%, or about 75% to 90% or more.
  • the subject methods are effective in reducing serum antitype II collagen levels by at least about 10%, 12%, 15%, 20%, 24%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 50%, 60%, 75%, 80%, 86%, 87%, or about 90% or more.
  • the subject methods are effective in reducing ankle histopathology scores by about 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 75%, 80%, 90% or more.
  • the subject methods are effective in reducing knee histopathology scores by about 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 75%, 80%, 90% or more.
  • PI3K-6 and/or ⁇ 3 ⁇ - ⁇ can provide advantages over using less selective compounds which inhibit PI3K-a and/or - ⁇ , such as an improved side effects profile or lessened reduction in the ability to reduce a bacterial, viral, and/or fungal infection.
  • a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, to treat respiratory diseases including, but not limited to diseases affecting the lobes of lung, pleural cavity, bronchial tubes, trachea, upper respiratory tract, or the nerves and muscle for breathing.
  • respiratory diseases including, but not limited to diseases affecting the lobes of lung, pleural cavity, bronchial tubes, trachea, upper respiratory tract, or the nerves and muscle for breathing.
  • methods are provided to treat obstructive pulmonary disease.
  • COPD chronic obstructive pulmonary disease
  • COPD chronic obstructive pulmonary disease
  • Conditions included in this umbrella term include, but are not limited to: chronic bronchitis, emphysema, and bronchiectasis.
  • the compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein are used for the treatment of asthma.
  • the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions described herein can be used for the treatment of endotoxemia and sepsis.
  • the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions described herein are used to for the treatment of rheumatoid arthritis (RA).
  • RA rheumatoid arthritis
  • the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions described herein is used for the treatment of contact or atopic dermatitis.
  • Contact dermatitis includes irritant dermatitis, phototoxic dermatitis, allergic dermatitis, photoallergic dermatitis, contact urticaria, systemic contact- type dermatitis and the like. Irritant dermatitis can occur when too much of a substance is used on the skin of when the skin is sensitive to certain substance.
  • Atopic dermatitis sometimes called eczema, is a kind of dermatitis, an atopic skin disease.
  • the disclosure provides a method of treating diseases related to vasculogenesis or angiogenesis in a subject that comprises administering to said subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • said method is for treating a disease selected from tumor angiogenesis, chronic inflammatory disease such as rheumatoid arthritis and chronic inflammatory demyelinating polyneuropathy, atherosclerosis, inflammatory bowel disease, skin diseases such as psoriasis, eczema, and scleroderma, diabetes, diabetic retinopathy, retinopathy of prematurity, age-related macular degeneration, hemangioma, glioma, melanoma, Kaposi's sarcoma and ovarian, breast, lung, pancreatic, prostate, colon and epidermoid cancer.
  • chronic inflammatory disease such as rheumatoid arthritis and chronic inflammatory demyelinating polyneuropathy
  • atherosclerosis such as rheumatoid arthritis and chronic inflammatory demyelinating polyneuropathy
  • inflammatory bowel disease such as psoriasis, eczema, and scleroderma
  • diabetes
  • arteriosclerosis is a general term describing any hardening of medium or large arteries.
  • Atherosclerosis is a hardening of an artery specifically due to an atheromatous plaque.
  • a method of treating a cardiovascular disease in a subject comprises administering to said subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound as provided herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof.
  • cardiovascular conditions include, but are not limited to, atherosclerosis, restenosis, vascular occlusion and carotid obstructive disease.
  • the disclosure relates to a method of treating diabetes in a subject that comprises administering to said subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound as provided herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • the compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • the inflammatory condition and/or immune disorder is a skin condition.
  • the skin condition is pruritus (itch), psoriasis, eczema, burns or dermatitis.
  • the skin condition is psoriasis.
  • the skin condition is pruritis.
  • the inflammatory disorder and/or the immune disorder is a gastrointestinal disorder.
  • the gastrointestinal disorder is selected from gastrointestinal disorder (e.g., selected from peptic ulcers, regional enteritis, diverticulitis, gastrointestinal bleeding, eosinophilic gastrointestinal disorders (e.g. , eosinophilic esophagitis, eosinophilic gastritis, eosinophilic gastroenteritis, eosinophilic colitis), gastritis, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux disease (GORD, or its synonym GERD), inflammatory bowel disease (IBD) (e.g.
  • the gastrointestinal disorder is inflammatory bowel disease (IBD).
  • the compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein can be used for the treatment of glomerulonephritis.
  • Glomerulonephritis is a primary or secondary autoimmune renal disease characterized by inflammation of the glomeruli. It can be asymptomatic, or present with hematuria and/or proteinuria. There are many recognized types, divided in acute, subacute or chronic glomerulonephritis. Causes are infectious (bacterial, viral or parasitic pathogens), autoimmune or paraneoplastic.
  • compositions as provided herein for the treatment of multiorgan failure.
  • compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, for the treatment of liver diseases (including diabetes), gall bladder disease (inluding gallstones), pancreatitis or kidney disease (including proliferative glomerulonephritis and diabetes- induced renal disease) or pain in a subject.
  • provided herein are compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, for the prevention of blastocyte implantation in a subject.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • thrombocytopenic purpura e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein for the treatment of disorders involving platelet aggregation or platelet adhesion, including, but not limited to Idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura, Bernard- Soulier syndrome, Glanzmann's thrombasthenia, Scott's syndrome, von Willebrand disease, Hermansky-Pudlak Syndrome, and Gray platelet syndrome.
  • compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein are provided for treating a disease which is skeletal muscle atrophy, skeletal or muscle hypertrophy.
  • provided herein are compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, for the treatment of disorders that include, but are not limited to, cancers as discussed herein, transplantation-related disorders (e.g., lowering rejection rates, graft-versus-host disease, etc.), muscular sclerosis (MS), allergic disorders (e.g., arthritis, allergic encephalomyelitis) and other immunosuppressive -related disorders, metabolic disorders (e.g., diabetes), reducing intimal thickening following vascular injury, and misfolded protein disorders (e.g., Alzheimer's Disease, Gaucher's Disease, Parkinson's Disease, Huntington's Disease, cystic fibrosis, macular degeneration, retinitis pigmentosa, and prion disorders) (as mTOR inhibition can alleviate the effects of misfold
  • the compounds, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein can be used for the treatment of bursitis, lupus, acute disseminated encephalomyelitis (ADEM), Addison's disease, antiphospholipid antibody syndrome (APS), amyloidosis (including systemic and localized amyloidosis; and primary and secondary amyloidosis), aplastic anemia, autoimmune hepatitis, coeliac disease, Crohn's disease, diabetes mellitus (type 1), eosinophilic gastroenterides, goodpasture's syndrome, graves' disease, guillain-barre syndrome (GBS), hashimoto's disease, inflammatory bowel disease, lupus erythematosus (including cutaneous lupus erythemat
  • a leukocyte or disrupting a function of an osteoclast includes contacting the leukocyte or the osteoclast with a function disrupting amount of a compound as provided herein.
  • methods are provided for treating ophthalmic disease by administering one or more of the subject compounds or pharmaceutical compositions to the eye of a subject.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • a disease or a disorder using a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, wherein the disease or disorder is: ankylosing spondylitis; chronic obstructive pulmonary disease; myasthenia gravis; ocular uveitis, psoriasis; and psoriatic arthritis.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • a disease or a disorder using a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, wherein the disease or disorder is: adult-onset Still's disease; inflammatory alopecia; amyloidosis; antiphospholipid syndrome; autoimmune hepatitis; autoimmune skin disease, Behcet's disease; chronic inflammatory demyelinating polyneuropathy; eosinophilic gastroenteritis; inflammatory myopathies, pemphigus, polymyalgia rheumatica; relapsing polychondritis; Sjorgen's syndrome; temporal arthritis; ulcerative colitis; vasculis; vitiligo, and Wegner's granulomatosis.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, iso
  • provided herein are methods of treating, preventing and/or managing a disease or a disorder using a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, wherein the disease or disorder is: gout flare; sacoidosis; and systemic sclerosis.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • a disease or a disorder using a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable form (e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives) thereof, or pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, wherein the disease or disorder is: asthma; arthritis (e.g., rheumatoid arthritis and psoriatic arthritis); psoriasis; scleroderma; myositis (e.g., dermatomyositis); lupus (e.g. , cutaneous lupus erythematosus ("CLE”) or systemic lupus erythematosus (“SLE”)); or Sjogren's syndrome.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable form e.g., pharmaceutically acceptable salts, hydrates, solvates, isomers, prodrugs, and isotopically labeled derivatives
  • pharmaceutical compositions as provided herein, wherein the disease or disorder
  • Efficacy of a compound provided herein in treating, preventing and/or managing the disease or disorder can be tested using various animal models known in the art. For example: efficacy in treating, preventing and/or managing asthma can be assessed using ova induced asthma model described, for example, in Lee et al. (2006) J Allergy Clin Immunol 118(2):403-9; efficacy in treating, preventing and/or managing arthritis (e.g., rheumatoid or psoriatic arthritis) can be assessed using autoimmune animal models described, for example, in Williams et al.
  • a method of treating, preventing and/or managing asthma encompasses airway constriction regardless of the cause.
  • Common triggers of asthma include, but are not limited to, exposure to an environmental stimulants (e.g. , allergens), cold air, warm air, perfume, moist air, exercise or exertion, and emotional stress.
  • an environmental stimulants e.g. , allergens
  • cold air warm air
  • perfume moist air
  • exercise or exertion e.g., exercise or exertion
  • emotional stress e.g., emotional stress.
  • a method of treating, preventing and/or managing one or more symptoms associated with asthma include, but are not limited to, severe coughing, airway constriction and mucus production.
  • a method of treating, preventing and/or managing arthritis encompasses all types and manifestations of arthritis. Examples include, but are not limited to, crystalline arthritis, osteoarthritis, psoriatic arthritis, gouty arthritis, reactive arthritis, rheumatoid arthritis and Reiter's arthritis.
  • the disease or disorder is rheumatoid arthritis.
  • the disease or disorder is psoriatic arthritis.
  • a method of treating, preventing and/or managing one or more symptoms associated with arthritis examples of the symptoms include, but are not limited to, joint pain, which progresses into joint deformation, or damages in body organs such as in blood vessels, heart, lungs, skin, and muscles.
  • psoriasis encompasses all types and manifestations of psoriasis. Examples include, but are not limited to, plaque psoriasis (e.g., chronic plaque psoriasis, moderate plaque psoriasis and severe plaque psoriasis), guttate psoriasis, inverse psoriasis, pustular psoriasis, pemphigus vulgaris, erythrodermic psoriasis, psoriasis associated with inflammatory bowel disease (IBD), and psoriasis associated with rheumatoid arthritis (RA).
  • plaque psoriasis e.g., chronic plaque psoriasis, moderate plaque psoriasis and severe plaque psoriasis
  • guttate psoriasis e.g., inverse psoriasis, pustular psoriasis, pemph
  • Also provided herein is a method of treating, preventing and/or managing one or more symptoms associated with psoriasis.
  • the symptoms include, but are not limited to: red patches of skin covered with silvery scales; small scaling spots; dry, cracked skin that may bleed; itching; burning; soreness; thickened, pitted or ridged nails; and swollen and stiff joints.
  • fibrosis or “fibrotic condition encompasses all types and manifestations of fibrosis or fibrotic condition. Examples include, but are not limited to, formation or deposition of tissue fibrosis; reducing the size, cellularity (e.g. , fibroblast or immune cell numbers), composition; or cellular content, of a fibrotic lesion; reducing the collagen or hydroxyproline content, of a fibrotic lesion; reducing expression or activity of a fibrogenic protein; reducing fibrosis associated with an inflammatory response; decreasing weight loss associated with fibrosis; or increasing survival.
  • tissue fibrosis reducing the size, cellularity (e.g. , fibroblast or immune cell numbers), composition; or cellular content, of a fibrotic lesion; reducing the collagen or hydroxyproline content, of a fibrotic lesion; reducing expression or activity of a fibrogenic protein; reducing fibrosis associated with an inflammatory response; decreasing weight loss associated with fibrosis; or increasing survival.
  • the fibrotic condition is primary fibrosis.
  • the fibrotic condition is idiopathic.
  • the fibrotic condition is associated with (e.g., is secondary to) a disease (e.g. , an infectious disease, an inflammatory disease, an autoimmune disease, a malignant or cancerous disease, and/or a connective disease); a toxin; an insult (e.g., an environmental hazard (e.g., asbestos, coal dust, polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbons), cigarette smoking, a wound); a medical treatment (e.g. , surgical incision, chemotherapy or radiation), or a combination thereof.
  • a disease e.g., an infectious disease, an inflammatory disease, an autoimmune disease, a malignant or cancerous disease, and/or a connective disease
  • a toxin e.g., an insult (e.g., an environmental hazard (e.g., asbestos, coal dust, polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbons), cigarette smoking, a wound);
  • the fibrotic condition is associated with an autoimmune disease selected from scleroderma or lupus, e.g. , systemic lupus erythematosus.
  • the fibrotic condition is systemic.
  • the fibrotic condition is systemic sclerosis (e.g., limited systemic sclerosis, diffuse systemic sclerosis, or systemic sclerosis sine scleroderma), nephrogenic systemic fibrosis, cystic fibrosis, chronic graft vs. host disease, or atherosclerosis.
  • the fibrotic condition is a fibrotic condition of the lung, a fibrotic condition of the liver, a fibrotic condition of the heart or vasculature, a fibrotic condition of the kidney, a fibrotic condition of the skin, a fibrotic condition of the gastrointestinal tract, a fibrotic condition of the bone marrow or a hematopoietic tissue, a fibrotic condition of the nervous system, a fibrotic condition of the eye, or a combination thereof.
  • the fibrotic condition affects a tissue chosen from one or more of muscle, tendon, cartilage, skin (e.g., skin epidermis or endodermis), cardiac tissue, vascular tissue (e.g. , artery, vein), pancreatic tissue, lung tissue, liver tissue, kidney tissue, uterine tissue, ovarian tissue, neural tissue, testicular tissue, peritoneal tissue, colon, small intestine, biliary tract, gut, bone marrow, hematopoietic tissue, or eye (e.g., retinal) tissue.
  • skin e.g., skin epidermis or endodermis
  • cardiac tissue e.g., vascular tissue (e.g. , artery, vein)
  • pancreatic tissue e.g. , lung tissue, liver tissue, kidney tissue, uterine tissue, ovarian tissue
  • neural tissue e.g., testicular tissue, peritoneal tissue, colon, small intestine, biliary tract, gut, bone m
  • the fibrotic condition is a fibrotic condition of the eye.
  • the fibrotic condition is glaucoma, macular degeneration (e.g., age-related macular degeneration), macular edema (e.g., diabetic macular edema), retinopathy (e.g., diabetic retinopathy), or dry eye disease.
  • macular degeneration e.g., age-related macular degeneration
  • macular edema e.g., diabetic macular edema
  • retinopathy e.g., diabetic retinopathy
  • dry eye disease e.g., diabetic retinopathy
  • the fibrotic condition is a fibrotic condition of the lung.
  • the fibrotic condition of the lung is chosen from one or more of: pulmonary fibrosis, idiopathic pulmonary fibrosis (IPF), usual interstitial pneumonitis (UIP), interstitial lung disease, cryptogenic fibrosing alveolitis (CFA), bronchiectasis, and scleroderma lung disease.
  • the fibrosis of the lung is secondary to a disease, a toxin, an insult, a medical treatment, or a combination thereof.
  • the fibrosis of the lung can be associated with (e.g., secondary to) one or more of: a disease process such as asbestosis and silicosis; an occupational hazard; an environmental pollutant; cigarette smoking; an autoimmune connective tissue disorders (e.g., rheumatoid arthritis, scleroderma and systemic lupus erythematosus (SLE)); a connective tissue disorder such as sarcoidosis; an infectious disease, e.g., infection, particularly chronic infection; a medical treatment, including but not limited to, radiation therapy, and drug therapy, e.g., chemotherapy (e.g., treatment with as bleomycin, methotrexate, amiodarone, busulfan, and/or nitrofurantoin).
  • the fibrotic condition of the lung treated with the methods of the invention is associated with (e.g. , secondary to) a cancer treatment, e.g., treatment of a cancer (e.g., squamous cell carcinoma, testicular cancer, Hodgkin's disease with bleomycin).
  • a cancer e.g., squamous cell carcinoma, testicular cancer, Hodgkin's disease with bleomycin
  • the fibrotic condition of the lung is associated with an autoimmune connective tissue disorder (e.g., scleroderma or lupus, e.g., SLE).
  • the fibrotic condition is a fibrotic condition of the liver.
  • the fibrotic condition of the liver is chosen from one or more of: fatty liver disease, steatosis (e.g., nonalcoholic steatohepatitis (NASH), cholestatic liver disease (e.g., primary biliary cirrhosis (PBC)), cirrhosis, alcohol induced liver fibrosis, biliary duct injury, biliary fibrosis, or cholangiopathies.
  • steatosis e.g., nonalcoholic steatohepatitis (NASH)
  • cholestatic liver disease e.g., primary biliary cirrhosis (PBC)
  • PBC primary biliary cirrhosis
  • alcohol induced liver fibrosis biliary duct injury
  • biliary fibrosis or cholangiopathies.
  • hepatic or liver fibrosis includes, but is not limited to, hepatic fibrosis associated with alcoholism, viral infection, e.g., hepatitis (e.g. , hepatitis C, B or D), autoimmune hepatitis, non-alcoholic fatty liver disease (NAFLD), progressive massive fibrosis, exposure to toxins or irritants (e.g. , alcohol, pharmaceutical drugs and environmental toxins).
  • hepatitis e.g. , hepatitis C, B or D
  • NAFLD non-alcoholic fatty liver disease
  • progressive massive fibrosis e.g., alcohol, pharmaceutical drugs and environmental toxins.
  • the fibrotic condition is a fibrotic condition of the heart.
  • the fibrotic condition of the heart is myocardial fibrosis (e.g. , myocardial fibrosis associated with radiation myocarditis, a surgical procedure complication (e.g. , myocardial post-operative fibrosis), infectious diseases (e.g. , Chagas disease, bacterial, trichinosis or fungal myocarditis)); granulomatous, metabolic storage disorders (e.g.
  • the myocardial fibrosis is associated with an inflammatory disorder of cardiac tissue (e.g. , myocardial sarcoidosis).
  • the fibrotic condition is a fibrotic condition associated with a myocardial infarction.
  • the fibrotic condition is a fibrotic condition associated with congestive heart failure.

Abstract

L'invention concerne des composés (I) et des compositions pharmaceutiques qui modulent l'activité des kinases, notamment l'activité de la kinase PI13, ainsi que des composés, des compositions pharmaceutiques et des méthodes de traitement de maladies et d'affections associées à l'activité des kinases, notamment l'activité de la kinase PI3.
PCT/US2015/027926 2014-04-29 2015-04-28 Dérivés de pyrimidine ou de pyridine utiles en tant qu'inhibiteurs de pi3k WO2015168079A1 (fr)

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US201461986035P 2014-04-29 2014-04-29
US61/986,035 2014-04-29

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2015168079A1 true WO2015168079A1 (fr) 2015-11-05

Family

ID=53055133

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2015/027926 WO2015168079A1 (fr) 2014-04-29 2015-04-28 Dérivés de pyrimidine ou de pyridine utiles en tant qu'inhibiteurs de pi3k

Country Status (1)

Country Link
WO (1) WO2015168079A1 (fr)

Cited By (24)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20160024054A1 (en) * 2014-06-24 2016-01-28 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
US9670163B2 (en) 2005-12-28 2017-06-06 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Solid forms of N-[2,4-bis(1,1-dimethylethyl)-5-hydroxyphenyl]-1,4-dihydro-4-oxoquinoline-3-carboxamide
WO2017112951A1 (fr) * 2015-12-24 2017-06-29 The Regents Of The University Of California Régulateurs cftr et leurs méthodes d'utilisation
WO2017112950A1 (fr) * 2015-12-24 2017-06-29 The Regents Of The University Of California Régulateurs cftr et méthodes pour les utiliser
US9944639B2 (en) 2014-07-04 2018-04-17 Lupin Limited Quinolizinone derivatives as PI3K inhibitors
WO2017188720A3 (fr) * 2016-04-29 2018-07-26 Yuhan Corporation Dérivé de quinazoline ou son sel et composition pharmaceutique le comprenant
US10092563B2 (en) 2014-06-13 2018-10-09 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
US10221197B2 (en) 2014-06-13 2019-03-05 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
US10308639B2 (en) 2014-06-13 2019-06-04 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
CN110003192A (zh) * 2018-01-04 2019-07-12 广东东阳光药业有限公司 取代的氨基嘧啶类化合物及其使用方法和用途
CN111386264A (zh) * 2017-07-31 2020-07-07 纽约市哥伦比亚大学理事会 用于治疗t-细胞急性淋巴细胞白血病的化合物、组合物和方法
JP2021511312A (ja) * 2018-01-17 2021-05-06 バーテックス ファーマシューティカルズ インコーポレイテッドVertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated ゲノム編集効率を増加するためのキノキサリノン化合物、組成物、方法、およびキット
JP2021512052A (ja) * 2018-01-20 2021-05-13 サンシャイン・レイク・ファーマ・カンパニー・リミテッドSunshine Lake Pharma Co.,Ltd. 置換アミノピリミジン化合物及び使用方法
US11021467B2 (en) 2014-06-13 2021-06-01 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
WO2022117016A1 (fr) * 2020-12-02 2022-06-09 深圳微芯生物科技股份有限公司 Composé hydroxamate, son procédé de préparation et son application
CN115210280A (zh) * 2020-03-05 2022-10-18 波音公司 席夫碱低聚物
US11661422B2 (en) 2020-08-27 2023-05-30 Incyte Corporation Tricyclic urea compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11691971B2 (en) 2020-06-19 2023-07-04 Incyte Corporation Naphthyridinone compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11753413B2 (en) 2020-06-19 2023-09-12 Incyte Corporation Substituted pyrrolo[2,1-f][1,2,4]triazine compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11767323B2 (en) 2020-07-02 2023-09-26 Incyte Corporation Tricyclic pyridone compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11780840B2 (en) 2020-07-02 2023-10-10 Incyte Corporation Tricyclic urea compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11839616B2 (en) 2017-08-24 2023-12-12 The Regents Of The University Of California Ocular pharmaceutical compositions
US11919908B2 (en) 2020-12-21 2024-03-05 Incyte Corporation Substituted pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidine compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11958861B2 (en) 2022-02-24 2024-04-16 Incyte Corporation Spirocyclic lactams as JAK2 V617F inhibitors

Citations (126)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3536809A (en) 1969-02-17 1970-10-27 Alza Corp Medication method
US3598123A (en) 1969-04-01 1971-08-10 Alza Corp Bandage for administering drugs
US3845770A (en) 1972-06-05 1974-11-05 Alza Corp Osmatic dispensing device for releasing beneficial agent
US3916899A (en) 1973-04-25 1975-11-04 Alza Corp Osmotic dispensing device with maximum and minimum sizes for the passageway
US4008719A (en) 1976-02-02 1977-02-22 Alza Corporation Osmotic system having laminar arrangement for programming delivery of active agent
US4270537A (en) 1979-11-19 1981-06-02 Romaine Richard A Automatic hypodermic syringe
US4596556A (en) 1985-03-25 1986-06-24 Bioject, Inc. Hypodermic injection apparatus
US4790824A (en) 1987-06-19 1988-12-13 Bioject, Inc. Non-invasive hypodermic injection device
US4886499A (en) 1986-12-18 1989-12-12 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Portable injection appliance
WO1990005719A1 (fr) 1988-11-23 1990-05-31 British Bio-Technology Limited Inhibiteurs de collagenase a base d'acide hydroxamique
US4940460A (en) 1987-06-19 1990-07-10 Bioject, Inc. Patient-fillable and non-invasive hypodermic injection device assembly
US4941880A (en) 1987-06-19 1990-07-17 Bioject, Inc. Pre-filled ampule and non-invasive hypodermic injection device assembly
US4992445A (en) 1987-06-12 1991-02-12 American Cyanamid Co. Transdermal delivery of pharmaceuticals
US5001139A (en) 1987-06-12 1991-03-19 American Cyanamid Company Enchancers for the transdermal flux of nivadipine
US5015235A (en) 1987-02-20 1991-05-14 National Carpet Equipment, Inc. Syringe needle combination
US5023252A (en) 1985-12-04 1991-06-11 Conrex Pharmaceutical Corporation Transdermal and trans-membrane delivery of drugs
US5059595A (en) 1989-03-22 1991-10-22 Bioresearch, S.P.A. Pharmaceutical compositions containing 5-methyltetrahydrofolic acid, 5-formyltetrahydrofolic acid and their pharmaceutically acceptable salts in controlled-release form active in the therapy of organic mental disturbances
US5064413A (en) 1989-11-09 1991-11-12 Bioject, Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
US5073543A (en) 1988-07-21 1991-12-17 G. D. Searle & Co. Controlled release formulations of trophic factors in ganglioside-lipsome vehicle
US5120548A (en) 1989-11-07 1992-06-09 Merck & Co., Inc. Swelling modulated polymeric drug delivery device
US5141496A (en) 1988-11-03 1992-08-25 Tino Dalto Spring impelled syringe guide with skin penetration depth adjustment
US5190521A (en) 1990-08-22 1993-03-02 Tecnol Medical Products, Inc. Apparatus and method for raising a skin wheal and anesthetizing skin
US5312335A (en) 1989-11-09 1994-05-17 Bioject Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
US5328483A (en) 1992-02-27 1994-07-12 Jacoby Richard M Intradermal injection device with medication and needle guard
EP0606046A1 (fr) 1993-01-06 1994-07-13 Ciba-Geigy Ag Arylsulfonamido-substitués dérivés d'acides hydroxamic
US5334144A (en) 1992-10-30 1994-08-02 Becton, Dickinson And Company Single use disposable needleless injector
US5339163A (en) 1988-03-16 1994-08-16 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Automatic exposure control device using plural image plane detection areas
US5354556A (en) 1984-10-30 1994-10-11 Elan Corporation, Plc Controlled release powder and process for its preparation
US5383851A (en) 1992-07-24 1995-01-24 Bioject Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
US5417662A (en) 1991-09-13 1995-05-23 Pharmacia Ab Injection needle arrangement
US5466220A (en) 1994-03-08 1995-11-14 Bioject, Inc. Drug vial mixing and transfer device
US5480381A (en) 1991-08-23 1996-01-02 Weston Medical Limited Needle-less injector
US5527288A (en) 1990-12-13 1996-06-18 Elan Medical Technologies Limited Intradermal drug delivery device and method for intradermal delivery of drugs
WO1996027583A1 (fr) 1995-03-08 1996-09-12 Pfizer Inc. Derives de l'acide arylsulfonylamino hydroxamique
WO1996033172A1 (fr) 1995-04-20 1996-10-24 Pfizer Inc. Derives d'acide hydroxamique arylsufonyle en tant qu'inhibiteurs de mmp et de tnf
US5569189A (en) 1992-09-28 1996-10-29 Equidyne Systems, Inc. hypodermic jet injector
US5591767A (en) 1993-01-25 1997-01-07 Pharmetrix Corporation Liquid reservoir transdermal patch for the administration of ketorolac
US5599302A (en) 1995-01-09 1997-02-04 Medi-Ject Corporation Medical injection system and method, gas spring thereof and launching device using gas spring
WO1997013537A1 (fr) 1995-10-10 1997-04-17 Visionary Medical Products Corporation Dispositif d'injection sans aiguille et a gaz comprime
US5639480A (en) 1989-07-07 1997-06-17 Sandoz Ltd. Sustained release formulations of water soluble peptides
US5639476A (en) 1992-01-27 1997-06-17 Euro-Celtique, S.A. Controlled release formulations coated with aqueous dispersions of acrylic polymers
EP0780386A1 (fr) 1995-12-20 1997-06-25 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Inhibiteurs de métalloprotéases matricielles
US5649912A (en) 1994-03-07 1997-07-22 Bioject, Inc. Ampule filling device
US5674533A (en) 1994-07-07 1997-10-07 Recordati, S.A., Chemical And Pharmaceutical Company Pharmaceutical composition for the controlled release of moguisteine in a liquid suspension
WO1997037705A1 (fr) 1996-04-11 1997-10-16 Weston Medical Limited Distributeur a usage medical entraine par ressort
WO1998003516A1 (fr) 1996-07-18 1998-01-29 Pfizer Inc. Composes a base de phosphinate inhibiteurs des metalloproteases matricielles
WO1998007697A1 (fr) 1996-08-23 1998-02-26 Pfizer Inc. Derives de l'acide arylsulfonylamino hydroxamique
US5733566A (en) 1990-05-15 1998-03-31 Alkermes Controlled Therapeutics Inc. Ii Controlled release of antiparasitic agents in animals
US5739108A (en) 1984-10-04 1998-04-14 Monsanto Company Prolonged release of biologically active polypeptides
WO1998030566A1 (fr) 1997-01-06 1998-07-16 Pfizer Inc. Derives de sulfone cyclique
WO1998033768A1 (fr) 1997-02-03 1998-08-06 Pfizer Products Inc. Derives d'acide arylsulfonylaminohydroxamique
WO1998034918A1 (fr) 1997-02-11 1998-08-13 Pfizer Inc. Derives de l'acide arylsulfonylhydroxamique
WO1998034915A1 (fr) 1997-02-07 1998-08-13 Pfizer Inc. Derives du n-hxdroxy-beta-sulfonyl-propionamide et leur utilisation comme inhibiteurs des metalloproteases matrices
US5891474A (en) 1997-01-29 1999-04-06 Poli Industria Chimica, S.P.A. Time-specific controlled release dosage formulations and method of preparing same
US5893397A (en) 1996-01-12 1999-04-13 Bioject Inc. Medication vial/syringe liquid-transfer apparatus
WO1999029667A1 (fr) 1997-12-05 1999-06-17 Pfizer Limited Derives d'acide hydroxamique utilises comme inhibiteurs de metalloproteases matricielles
US5922356A (en) 1996-10-09 1999-07-13 Sumitomo Pharmaceuticals Company, Limited Sustained release formulation
WO1999034850A1 (fr) 1998-01-08 1999-07-15 Fiderm S.R.L. Dispositif de commande de la profondeur de penetration d'une aiguille conçu pour etre utilise avec une seringue d'injection
EP0931788A2 (fr) 1998-01-27 1999-07-28 Pfizer Limited Inhibiteurs de la métalloprotéinase
WO1999052889A1 (fr) 1998-04-10 1999-10-21 Pfizer Products Inc. Hydroxamides de l'acide (4-arylsulfonylamino)-tetrahydropyrane-4-carboxylique
WO1999052910A1 (fr) 1998-04-10 1999-10-21 Pfizer Products Inc. Derives bicycliques de l'acide hydroxamique
US5972891A (en) 1992-12-07 1999-10-26 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation
US5980945A (en) 1996-01-16 1999-11-09 Societe De Conseils De Recherches Et D'applications Scientifique S.A. Sustained release drug formulations
US5993412A (en) 1997-05-19 1999-11-30 Bioject, Inc. Injection apparatus
US5993855A (en) 1995-09-18 1999-11-30 Shiseido Company, Ltd. Delayed drug-releasing microspheres
US6045830A (en) 1995-09-04 2000-04-04 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Method of production of sustained-release preparation
US6087324A (en) 1993-06-24 2000-07-11 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation
US6113943A (en) 1996-10-31 2000-09-05 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation capable of releasing a physiologically active substance
US6197350B1 (en) 1996-12-20 2001-03-06 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Method of producing a sustained-release preparation
WO2001019800A2 (fr) 1999-09-16 2001-03-22 Curis, Inc. Mediateurs de voies de signalisation hedgehog, preparations et utilisations associees
WO2001027135A2 (fr) 1999-10-13 2001-04-19 Johns Hopkins University School Of Medicine Regulateurs du signal hedgehog, compositions et utilisations desdits regulateurs
WO2001026644A2 (fr) 1999-10-14 2001-04-19 Curis, Inc. Mediateurs de voies de signalisation hedgehog, compositions et utilisations associees
US6248363B1 (en) 1999-11-23 2001-06-19 Lipocine, Inc. Solid carriers for improved delivery of active ingredients in pharmaceutical compositions
WO2001049279A2 (fr) 1999-12-30 2001-07-12 Yeda Research And Development Co. Ltd. Utilisation d'alcaloides steroidiques pour neutraliser la resistance a l'action de plusieurs medicaments
US6264970B1 (en) 1996-06-26 2001-07-24 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation
US6267981B1 (en) 1995-06-27 2001-07-31 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Method of producing sustained-release preparation
WO2001074344A2 (fr) 2000-03-30 2001-10-11 Curis, Inc. Petits regulateurs de molecules organiques de proliferation de cellules
WO2001081346A2 (fr) 2000-04-25 2001-11-01 Icos Corporation Inhibiteurs de la phosphatidyl-inositol 3-kinase delta humaine
US20020006931A1 (en) 1998-04-09 2002-01-17 Philip A. Beachy Inhibitors of hedgehog signaling pathways, compositions and uses related thereto
US6419961B1 (en) 1996-08-29 2002-07-16 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained release microcapsules of a bioactive substance and a biodegradable polymer
WO2003011219A2 (fr) 2001-07-27 2003-02-13 Curis, Inc. Mediateurs des voies de signalisation hedgehog, compositions associees et utilisations de ces dernieres
US6589548B1 (en) 1998-05-16 2003-07-08 Mogam Biotechnology Research Institute Controlled drug delivery system using the conjugation of drug to biodegradable polyester
US6613358B2 (en) 1998-03-18 2003-09-02 Theodore W. Randolph Sustained-release composition including amorphous polymer
WO2003088970A2 (fr) 2002-04-22 2003-10-30 Johns Hopkins University School Of Medicine Modulateurs de voies de signalisation hedgehog, compositions et utilisations associees
WO2004020599A2 (fr) 2002-08-29 2004-03-11 Curis, Inc. Antagonistes de la voie hedgehog, methodes et applications correspondantes
WO2005013800A2 (fr) 2003-07-15 2005-02-17 The Johns Hopkins University Activite elevee du mecanisme hedgehog dans des tumeurs du systeme digestif, et methodes de traitement de tumeurs du systeme digestif presentant une activite elevee du mecanisme hedgehog
WO2005033288A2 (fr) 2003-09-29 2005-04-14 The Johns Hopkins University Antagonistes de la voie hedgehog
WO2005032343A2 (fr) 2003-10-01 2005-04-14 The Johns Hopkins University Signalisation hedgehog dans la regeneration, la neoplasie et la metastase prostatique
WO2005042700A2 (fr) 2003-10-20 2005-05-12 The Johns Hopkins University Utilisation d'inhibiteurs de la voie hedgehog dans le cancer pulmonaire à petites cellules
WO2005113556A1 (fr) 2004-05-13 2005-12-01 Icos Corporation Quinazolinones utilisees en tant qu'inhibiteurs de la phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase delta humaine
WO2006028958A2 (fr) 2004-09-02 2006-03-16 Genentech, Inc. Inhibiteurs pyridyles de la signalisation hedgehog
WO2006050351A2 (fr) 2004-10-28 2006-05-11 Irm Llc Composes et compositions servant de modulateurs de la voie de signalisation hedgehog
WO2006078283A2 (fr) 2004-04-30 2006-07-27 Genentech, Inc. Inhibiteurs de quinoxaline de la voie de signalisation hedgehog
US20070021493A1 (en) 1999-09-16 2007-01-25 Curis, Inc. Mediators of hedgehog signaling pathways, compositions and uses related thereto
US20070060546A1 (en) 2003-01-22 2007-03-15 Centre National De La Recherche Scientif Novel use of mifepristone and derivatives therefor as hedgehog protein signaling pathway modulators and applications of same
WO2007054623A2 (fr) 2005-11-11 2007-05-18 Licentia Oy Inhibiteurs de signalisation du herisson des mammiferes
WO2007059157A1 (fr) 2005-11-14 2007-05-24 Genentech, Inc. Inhibiteurs à base de bisamide du signal hedgehog
US7230004B2 (en) 2004-08-27 2007-06-12 Infinity Discovery, Inc. Cyclopamine analogues and methods of use thereof
WO2007120827A2 (fr) 2006-04-14 2007-10-25 Novartis Ag Utilisation de biarylcarboxamides dans le traitement de troubles associés à la voie hedgehog
WO2007131201A2 (fr) 2006-05-05 2007-11-15 Irm Llc Composés et compositions modulant le mécanisme d'action de la hedgehog
WO2008070357A2 (fr) 2006-10-31 2008-06-12 Government Of The United States Of America, Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services Polypeptides lissés et procédés d'utilisation
WO2008110611A1 (fr) 2007-03-15 2008-09-18 Novartis Ag Composés organiques et leurs utilisations
WO2008112913A1 (fr) 2007-03-14 2008-09-18 Exelixis, Inc. Inhibiteurs de la voie de signalisation du hérisson (voie hedgehog)
WO2008131354A2 (fr) 2007-04-20 2008-10-30 The Curators Of The University Of Missouri Phytoestrogènes en tant que régulateurs de signalisation hedgehog et procédés d'utilisation dans le traitement du cancer
US20080287420A1 (en) 2007-03-07 2008-11-20 Infinity Discovery, Inc. Cyclopamine lactam analogs and methods of use thereof
US20080293754A1 (en) 2006-12-28 2008-11-27 Brian Austad Cyclopamine analogs
US20080293755A1 (en) 2007-03-07 2008-11-27 Infinity Discovery, Inc. Heterocyclic cyclopamine analogs and methods of use thereof
WO2009088990A1 (fr) 2008-01-04 2009-07-16 Intellikine, Inc. Entités chimiques, compositions et procédés
WO2009088086A1 (fr) 2008-01-10 2009-07-16 Asahi Glass Company, Limited Verre, matière de revêtement pour dispositif émettant de la lumière et dispositif émettant de la lumière
WO2009088880A1 (fr) 2007-12-31 2009-07-16 Nortel Networks Limited Mise en oeuvre de réseaux privés virtuels (vpn) sur un réseau ethernet commandé par protocole d'état de liaison
WO2009114870A2 (fr) 2008-03-14 2009-09-17 Intellikine, Inc. Inhibiteurs de kinases, et procédés d’utilisation associés
US20090312310A1 (en) 2006-12-14 2009-12-17 Haruko Kawato Imidazothiazole derivatives
WO2010006086A2 (fr) 2008-07-08 2010-01-14 Intellikine, Inc. Inhibiteurs de kinases et procédés d'utilisation
US20100029693A1 (en) 2003-08-14 2010-02-04 Jason Douangpanya Novel pi3k delta inhibitors and methods of use thereof
WO2010036380A1 (fr) 2008-09-26 2010-04-01 Intellikine, Inc. Inhibiteurs hétérocycliques de kinases
US20100286114A1 (en) 2007-12-13 2010-11-11 Siena Biotech S.P.A. Hedgehog pathway antagonists and therapeutic applications thereof
WO2010129816A2 (fr) * 2009-05-07 2010-11-11 Intellikine, Inc. Composés hétérocycliques et leurs utilisations
US20100305096A1 (en) 2009-05-27 2010-12-02 Georgette Castanedo Bicyclic pyrimidine pi3k inhibitor compounds selective for p110 delta, and methods of use
US20100305084A1 (en) 2009-05-27 2010-12-02 Georgette Castanedo Bicyclic indole-pyrimidine pi3k inhibitor compounds selective for p110 delta, and methods of use
WO2011008302A1 (fr) 2009-07-15 2011-01-20 Intellikine, Inc. Certaines entités chimiques, compositions et procédés associés
WO2011041399A2 (fr) 2009-09-29 2011-04-07 Tyrogenex, Inc. Inhibiteurs sélectifs de la pi3k (delta)
WO2012064973A2 (fr) * 2010-11-10 2012-05-18 Infinity Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Composés hétérocycliques et utilisations de ceux-ci
WO2013032591A1 (fr) * 2011-08-29 2013-03-07 Infinity Pharmaceuticals Inc. Composés hétérocycliques et leurs utilisations
WO2013082540A1 (fr) 2011-12-02 2013-06-06 Gilead Calistoga Llc Compositions et procédés de traitement d'une maladie proliférative avec un dérivé quinazolinone
WO2013116562A1 (fr) * 2012-02-03 2013-08-08 Gilead Calistoga Llc Compositions et procédés de traitement d'une maladie avec (s)-4 amino-6-((1-(5-chloro-4-oxo-3-phényl-3,4-dihydroquinazoline-2-yl)éthyl)amino)pyrimidine-5-carbonitrile
WO2014100767A1 (fr) * 2012-12-21 2014-06-26 Gilead Calistoga Llc Inhibiteurs d'isoquinolinone phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase ou de quinazolinone phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase

Patent Citations (138)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3536809A (en) 1969-02-17 1970-10-27 Alza Corp Medication method
US3598123A (en) 1969-04-01 1971-08-10 Alza Corp Bandage for administering drugs
US3845770A (en) 1972-06-05 1974-11-05 Alza Corp Osmatic dispensing device for releasing beneficial agent
US3916899A (en) 1973-04-25 1975-11-04 Alza Corp Osmotic dispensing device with maximum and minimum sizes for the passageway
US4008719A (en) 1976-02-02 1977-02-22 Alza Corporation Osmotic system having laminar arrangement for programming delivery of active agent
US4270537A (en) 1979-11-19 1981-06-02 Romaine Richard A Automatic hypodermic syringe
US5739108A (en) 1984-10-04 1998-04-14 Monsanto Company Prolonged release of biologically active polypeptides
US5354556A (en) 1984-10-30 1994-10-11 Elan Corporation, Plc Controlled release powder and process for its preparation
US4596556A (en) 1985-03-25 1986-06-24 Bioject, Inc. Hypodermic injection apparatus
US5023252A (en) 1985-12-04 1991-06-11 Conrex Pharmaceutical Corporation Transdermal and trans-membrane delivery of drugs
US4886499A (en) 1986-12-18 1989-12-12 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Portable injection appliance
US5015235A (en) 1987-02-20 1991-05-14 National Carpet Equipment, Inc. Syringe needle combination
US4992445A (en) 1987-06-12 1991-02-12 American Cyanamid Co. Transdermal delivery of pharmaceuticals
US5001139A (en) 1987-06-12 1991-03-19 American Cyanamid Company Enchancers for the transdermal flux of nivadipine
US4790824A (en) 1987-06-19 1988-12-13 Bioject, Inc. Non-invasive hypodermic injection device
US4940460A (en) 1987-06-19 1990-07-10 Bioject, Inc. Patient-fillable and non-invasive hypodermic injection device assembly
US4941880A (en) 1987-06-19 1990-07-17 Bioject, Inc. Pre-filled ampule and non-invasive hypodermic injection device assembly
US5339163A (en) 1988-03-16 1994-08-16 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Automatic exposure control device using plural image plane detection areas
US5073543A (en) 1988-07-21 1991-12-17 G. D. Searle & Co. Controlled release formulations of trophic factors in ganglioside-lipsome vehicle
US5141496A (en) 1988-11-03 1992-08-25 Tino Dalto Spring impelled syringe guide with skin penetration depth adjustment
WO1990005719A1 (fr) 1988-11-23 1990-05-31 British Bio-Technology Limited Inhibiteurs de collagenase a base d'acide hydroxamique
US5059595A (en) 1989-03-22 1991-10-22 Bioresearch, S.P.A. Pharmaceutical compositions containing 5-methyltetrahydrofolic acid, 5-formyltetrahydrofolic acid and their pharmaceutically acceptable salts in controlled-release form active in the therapy of organic mental disturbances
US5639480A (en) 1989-07-07 1997-06-17 Sandoz Ltd. Sustained release formulations of water soluble peptides
US5120548A (en) 1989-11-07 1992-06-09 Merck & Co., Inc. Swelling modulated polymeric drug delivery device
US5312335A (en) 1989-11-09 1994-05-17 Bioject Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
US5064413A (en) 1989-11-09 1991-11-12 Bioject, Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
US5503627A (en) 1989-11-09 1996-04-02 Bioject, Inc. Ampule for needleless injection
US5733566A (en) 1990-05-15 1998-03-31 Alkermes Controlled Therapeutics Inc. Ii Controlled release of antiparasitic agents in animals
US5190521A (en) 1990-08-22 1993-03-02 Tecnol Medical Products, Inc. Apparatus and method for raising a skin wheal and anesthetizing skin
US5527288A (en) 1990-12-13 1996-06-18 Elan Medical Technologies Limited Intradermal drug delivery device and method for intradermal delivery of drugs
US5480381A (en) 1991-08-23 1996-01-02 Weston Medical Limited Needle-less injector
US5417662A (en) 1991-09-13 1995-05-23 Pharmacia Ab Injection needle arrangement
US5639476A (en) 1992-01-27 1997-06-17 Euro-Celtique, S.A. Controlled release formulations coated with aqueous dispersions of acrylic polymers
US5328483A (en) 1992-02-27 1994-07-12 Jacoby Richard M Intradermal injection device with medication and needle guard
US5383851A (en) 1992-07-24 1995-01-24 Bioject Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
US5520639A (en) 1992-07-24 1996-05-28 Bioject, Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection methods and device
US5569189A (en) 1992-09-28 1996-10-29 Equidyne Systems, Inc. hypodermic jet injector
US5704911A (en) 1992-09-28 1998-01-06 Equidyne Systems, Inc. Needleless hypodermic jet injector
US5334144A (en) 1992-10-30 1994-08-02 Becton, Dickinson And Company Single use disposable needleless injector
US5972891A (en) 1992-12-07 1999-10-26 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation
EP0606046A1 (fr) 1993-01-06 1994-07-13 Ciba-Geigy Ag Arylsulfonamido-substitués dérivés d'acides hydroxamic
US5591767A (en) 1993-01-25 1997-01-07 Pharmetrix Corporation Liquid reservoir transdermal patch for the administration of ketorolac
US6376461B1 (en) 1993-06-24 2002-04-23 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation
US6087324A (en) 1993-06-24 2000-07-11 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation
US5649912A (en) 1994-03-07 1997-07-22 Bioject, Inc. Ampule filling device
US5466220A (en) 1994-03-08 1995-11-14 Bioject, Inc. Drug vial mixing and transfer device
US5674533A (en) 1994-07-07 1997-10-07 Recordati, S.A., Chemical And Pharmaceutical Company Pharmaceutical composition for the controlled release of moguisteine in a liquid suspension
US5599302A (en) 1995-01-09 1997-02-04 Medi-Ject Corporation Medical injection system and method, gas spring thereof and launching device using gas spring
WO1996027583A1 (fr) 1995-03-08 1996-09-12 Pfizer Inc. Derives de l'acide arylsulfonylamino hydroxamique
US5863949A (en) 1995-03-08 1999-01-26 Pfizer Inc Arylsulfonylamino hydroxamic acid derivatives
WO1996033172A1 (fr) 1995-04-20 1996-10-24 Pfizer Inc. Derives d'acide hydroxamique arylsufonyle en tant qu'inhibiteurs de mmp et de tnf
US5861510A (en) 1995-04-20 1999-01-19 Pfizer Inc Arylsulfonyl hydroxamic acid derivatives as MMP and TNF inhibitors
US6267981B1 (en) 1995-06-27 2001-07-31 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Method of producing sustained-release preparation
US6045830A (en) 1995-09-04 2000-04-04 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Method of production of sustained-release preparation
US5993855A (en) 1995-09-18 1999-11-30 Shiseido Company, Ltd. Delayed drug-releasing microspheres
WO1997013537A1 (fr) 1995-10-10 1997-04-17 Visionary Medical Products Corporation Dispositif d'injection sans aiguille et a gaz comprime
EP0780386A1 (fr) 1995-12-20 1997-06-25 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Inhibiteurs de métalloprotéases matricielles
US5893397A (en) 1996-01-12 1999-04-13 Bioject Inc. Medication vial/syringe liquid-transfer apparatus
US5980945A (en) 1996-01-16 1999-11-09 Societe De Conseils De Recherches Et D'applications Scientifique S.A. Sustained release drug formulations
WO1997037705A1 (fr) 1996-04-11 1997-10-16 Weston Medical Limited Distributeur a usage medical entraine par ressort
US6264970B1 (en) 1996-06-26 2001-07-24 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation
WO1998003516A1 (fr) 1996-07-18 1998-01-29 Pfizer Inc. Composes a base de phosphinate inhibiteurs des metalloproteases matricielles
WO1998007697A1 (fr) 1996-08-23 1998-02-26 Pfizer Inc. Derives de l'acide arylsulfonylamino hydroxamique
US6419961B1 (en) 1996-08-29 2002-07-16 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained release microcapsules of a bioactive substance and a biodegradable polymer
US5922356A (en) 1996-10-09 1999-07-13 Sumitomo Pharmaceuticals Company, Limited Sustained release formulation
US6699500B2 (en) 1996-10-31 2004-03-02 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation capable of releasing a physiologically active substance
US6113943A (en) 1996-10-31 2000-09-05 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Sustained-release preparation capable of releasing a physiologically active substance
US6197350B1 (en) 1996-12-20 2001-03-06 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Method of producing a sustained-release preparation
WO1998030566A1 (fr) 1997-01-06 1998-07-16 Pfizer Inc. Derives de sulfone cyclique
US5891474A (en) 1997-01-29 1999-04-06 Poli Industria Chimica, S.P.A. Time-specific controlled release dosage formulations and method of preparing same
WO1998033768A1 (fr) 1997-02-03 1998-08-06 Pfizer Products Inc. Derives d'acide arylsulfonylaminohydroxamique
WO1998034915A1 (fr) 1997-02-07 1998-08-13 Pfizer Inc. Derives du n-hxdroxy-beta-sulfonyl-propionamide et leur utilisation comme inhibiteurs des metalloproteases matrices
WO1998034918A1 (fr) 1997-02-11 1998-08-13 Pfizer Inc. Derives de l'acide arylsulfonylhydroxamique
US5993412A (en) 1997-05-19 1999-11-30 Bioject, Inc. Injection apparatus
WO1999029667A1 (fr) 1997-12-05 1999-06-17 Pfizer Limited Derives d'acide hydroxamique utilises comme inhibiteurs de metalloproteases matricielles
WO1999034850A1 (fr) 1998-01-08 1999-07-15 Fiderm S.R.L. Dispositif de commande de la profondeur de penetration d'une aiguille conçu pour etre utilise avec une seringue d'injection
EP0931788A2 (fr) 1998-01-27 1999-07-28 Pfizer Limited Inhibiteurs de la métalloprotéinase
US6613358B2 (en) 1998-03-18 2003-09-02 Theodore W. Randolph Sustained-release composition including amorphous polymer
US20020006931A1 (en) 1998-04-09 2002-01-17 Philip A. Beachy Inhibitors of hedgehog signaling pathways, compositions and uses related thereto
WO1999052910A1 (fr) 1998-04-10 1999-10-21 Pfizer Products Inc. Derives bicycliques de l'acide hydroxamique
WO1999052889A1 (fr) 1998-04-10 1999-10-21 Pfizer Products Inc. Hydroxamides de l'acide (4-arylsulfonylamino)-tetrahydropyrane-4-carboxylique
US6589548B1 (en) 1998-05-16 2003-07-08 Mogam Biotechnology Research Institute Controlled drug delivery system using the conjugation of drug to biodegradable polyester
US20070021493A1 (en) 1999-09-16 2007-01-25 Curis, Inc. Mediators of hedgehog signaling pathways, compositions and uses related thereto
WO2001019800A2 (fr) 1999-09-16 2001-03-22 Curis, Inc. Mediateurs de voies de signalisation hedgehog, preparations et utilisations associees
WO2001027135A2 (fr) 1999-10-13 2001-04-19 Johns Hopkins University School Of Medicine Regulateurs du signal hedgehog, compositions et utilisations desdits regulateurs
WO2001026644A2 (fr) 1999-10-14 2001-04-19 Curis, Inc. Mediateurs de voies de signalisation hedgehog, compositions et utilisations associees
US6248363B1 (en) 1999-11-23 2001-06-19 Lipocine, Inc. Solid carriers for improved delivery of active ingredients in pharmaceutical compositions
WO2001049279A2 (fr) 1999-12-30 2001-07-12 Yeda Research And Development Co. Ltd. Utilisation d'alcaloides steroidiques pour neutraliser la resistance a l'action de plusieurs medicaments
WO2001074344A2 (fr) 2000-03-30 2001-10-11 Curis, Inc. Petits regulateurs de molecules organiques de proliferation de cellules
WO2001081346A2 (fr) 2000-04-25 2001-11-01 Icos Corporation Inhibiteurs de la phosphatidyl-inositol 3-kinase delta humaine
US6800620B2 (en) 2000-04-25 2004-10-05 Icos Inhibitors of human phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase delta
WO2003011219A2 (fr) 2001-07-27 2003-02-13 Curis, Inc. Mediateurs des voies de signalisation hedgehog, compositions associees et utilisations de ces dernieres
WO2003088970A2 (fr) 2002-04-22 2003-10-30 Johns Hopkins University School Of Medicine Modulateurs de voies de signalisation hedgehog, compositions et utilisations associees
WO2004020599A2 (fr) 2002-08-29 2004-03-11 Curis, Inc. Antagonistes de la voie hedgehog, methodes et applications correspondantes
US20070060546A1 (en) 2003-01-22 2007-03-15 Centre National De La Recherche Scientif Novel use of mifepristone and derivatives therefor as hedgehog protein signaling pathway modulators and applications of same
WO2005013800A2 (fr) 2003-07-15 2005-02-17 The Johns Hopkins University Activite elevee du mecanisme hedgehog dans des tumeurs du systeme digestif, et methodes de traitement de tumeurs du systeme digestif presentant une activite elevee du mecanisme hedgehog
US20100029693A1 (en) 2003-08-14 2010-02-04 Jason Douangpanya Novel pi3k delta inhibitors and methods of use thereof
WO2005033288A2 (fr) 2003-09-29 2005-04-14 The Johns Hopkins University Antagonistes de la voie hedgehog
WO2005032343A2 (fr) 2003-10-01 2005-04-14 The Johns Hopkins University Signalisation hedgehog dans la regeneration, la neoplasie et la metastase prostatique
WO2005042700A2 (fr) 2003-10-20 2005-05-12 The Johns Hopkins University Utilisation d'inhibiteurs de la voie hedgehog dans le cancer pulmonaire à petites cellules
WO2006078283A2 (fr) 2004-04-30 2006-07-27 Genentech, Inc. Inhibiteurs de quinoxaline de la voie de signalisation hedgehog
WO2005113556A1 (fr) 2004-05-13 2005-12-01 Icos Corporation Quinazolinones utilisees en tant qu'inhibiteurs de la phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase delta humaine
US7230004B2 (en) 2004-08-27 2007-06-12 Infinity Discovery, Inc. Cyclopamine analogues and methods of use thereof
WO2006028958A2 (fr) 2004-09-02 2006-03-16 Genentech, Inc. Inhibiteurs pyridyles de la signalisation hedgehog
WO2006050351A2 (fr) 2004-10-28 2006-05-11 Irm Llc Composes et compositions servant de modulateurs de la voie de signalisation hedgehog
WO2007054623A2 (fr) 2005-11-11 2007-05-18 Licentia Oy Inhibiteurs de signalisation du herisson des mammiferes
WO2007059157A1 (fr) 2005-11-14 2007-05-24 Genentech, Inc. Inhibiteurs à base de bisamide du signal hedgehog
WO2007120827A2 (fr) 2006-04-14 2007-10-25 Novartis Ag Utilisation de biarylcarboxamides dans le traitement de troubles associés à la voie hedgehog
WO2007131201A2 (fr) 2006-05-05 2007-11-15 Irm Llc Composés et compositions modulant le mécanisme d'action de la hedgehog
WO2008070357A2 (fr) 2006-10-31 2008-06-12 Government Of The United States Of America, Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services Polypeptides lissés et procédés d'utilisation
US20100093625A1 (en) 2006-10-31 2010-04-15 The U.S.A., As Represented By The Secretary, Dept. Of Health And Human Service Smoothened polypeptides and methods of use
US20090312310A1 (en) 2006-12-14 2009-12-17 Haruko Kawato Imidazothiazole derivatives
US7812164B2 (en) 2006-12-28 2010-10-12 Infinity Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Cyclopamine analogs
US20080293754A1 (en) 2006-12-28 2008-11-27 Brian Austad Cyclopamine analogs
US20080293755A1 (en) 2007-03-07 2008-11-27 Infinity Discovery, Inc. Heterocyclic cyclopamine analogs and methods of use thereof
US20080287420A1 (en) 2007-03-07 2008-11-20 Infinity Discovery, Inc. Cyclopamine lactam analogs and methods of use thereof
WO2008112913A1 (fr) 2007-03-14 2008-09-18 Exelixis, Inc. Inhibiteurs de la voie de signalisation du hérisson (voie hedgehog)
WO2008110611A1 (fr) 2007-03-15 2008-09-18 Novartis Ag Composés organiques et leurs utilisations
WO2008131354A2 (fr) 2007-04-20 2008-10-30 The Curators Of The University Of Missouri Phytoestrogènes en tant que régulateurs de signalisation hedgehog et procédés d'utilisation dans le traitement du cancer
US20100286114A1 (en) 2007-12-13 2010-11-11 Siena Biotech S.P.A. Hedgehog pathway antagonists and therapeutic applications thereof
WO2009088880A1 (fr) 2007-12-31 2009-07-16 Nortel Networks Limited Mise en oeuvre de réseaux privés virtuels (vpn) sur un réseau ethernet commandé par protocole d'état de liaison
US20110046165A1 (en) 2008-01-04 2011-02-24 Pingda Ren Certain chemical entitles, compositions and methods
WO2009088986A1 (fr) 2008-01-04 2009-07-16 Intellikine, Inc. Entités chimiques, compositions et procédés
WO2009088990A1 (fr) 2008-01-04 2009-07-16 Intellikine, Inc. Entités chimiques, compositions et procédés
WO2009088086A1 (fr) 2008-01-10 2009-07-16 Asahi Glass Company, Limited Verre, matière de revêtement pour dispositif émettant de la lumière et dispositif émettant de la lumière
WO2009114870A2 (fr) 2008-03-14 2009-09-17 Intellikine, Inc. Inhibiteurs de kinases, et procédés d’utilisation associés
WO2010006086A2 (fr) 2008-07-08 2010-01-14 Intellikine, Inc. Inhibiteurs de kinases et procédés d'utilisation
WO2010036380A1 (fr) 2008-09-26 2010-04-01 Intellikine, Inc. Inhibiteurs hétérocycliques de kinases
WO2010129816A2 (fr) * 2009-05-07 2010-11-11 Intellikine, Inc. Composés hétérocycliques et leurs utilisations
US20100305096A1 (en) 2009-05-27 2010-12-02 Georgette Castanedo Bicyclic pyrimidine pi3k inhibitor compounds selective for p110 delta, and methods of use
US20100305084A1 (en) 2009-05-27 2010-12-02 Georgette Castanedo Bicyclic indole-pyrimidine pi3k inhibitor compounds selective for p110 delta, and methods of use
WO2011008302A1 (fr) 2009-07-15 2011-01-20 Intellikine, Inc. Certaines entités chimiques, compositions et procédés associés
WO2011041399A2 (fr) 2009-09-29 2011-04-07 Tyrogenex, Inc. Inhibiteurs sélectifs de la pi3k (delta)
WO2012064973A2 (fr) * 2010-11-10 2012-05-18 Infinity Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Composés hétérocycliques et utilisations de ceux-ci
WO2013032591A1 (fr) * 2011-08-29 2013-03-07 Infinity Pharmaceuticals Inc. Composés hétérocycliques et leurs utilisations
WO2013082540A1 (fr) 2011-12-02 2013-06-06 Gilead Calistoga Llc Compositions et procédés de traitement d'une maladie proliférative avec un dérivé quinazolinone
WO2013116562A1 (fr) * 2012-02-03 2013-08-08 Gilead Calistoga Llc Compositions et procédés de traitement d'une maladie avec (s)-4 amino-6-((1-(5-chloro-4-oxo-3-phényl-3,4-dihydroquinazoline-2-yl)éthyl)amino)pyrimidine-5-carbonitrile
WO2014100767A1 (fr) * 2012-12-21 2014-06-26 Gilead Calistoga Llc Inhibiteurs d'isoquinolinone phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase ou de quinazolinone phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase

Non-Patent Citations (186)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
"Basic and Clinical Pharmacology", 2003, MCGRAW HILL
"Bioreversible Carriers in Drug Design", 1987, AMERICAN PHARMACEUTICAL ASSOCIATION AND PERGAMON PRESS
"Burger's Medicinal Chemistry and Drug Discovery", vol. 172-178, 1995, pages: 949 - 982
"Design of Prodrugs", 1985, ELSELVIER
"Enantiomers, Racemates and Resolutions", 1981, WILEY INTERSCIENCE
"Handbook of Chemistry and Physics"
"Handbook of Clinical Drug Data", 2002, MCGRAW-HILL
"Principles of Drug Action", 1990
"Remingtons Pharmaceutical Sciences", 2000, LIPPINCOTT WILLIAMS & WILKINS
"Stereochemistry of Carbon Compounds", 1962, MCGRAW HILL
"Tables of Resolving Agents and Optical Resolutions", 1972, UNIV. OF NOTRE DAME PRESS, pages: 268
"The Pharmacological Basis of Therapeutics", 2001, MCGRAW HILL
AL-ALWAN MM ET AL., J IMMUNOL., vol. 178, no. 4, 2007, pages 2328 - 35
ALI K ET AL., J IMMUNOL., vol. 180, no. 4, 2008, pages 2538 - 44
ALI K ET AL., NATURE, vol. 431, no. 7011, 2004, pages 1007 - 11
ALI K, NATURE, vol. 431, no. 7011, 2004, pages 1007 - 11
ASBAHR, F.R. ET AL., AM. J. PSYCHIATRY, vol. 155, 1998, pages 1122 - 1124
BANSAL, N ET AL., CANCER CONTROL., vol. 16, no. 1, 2009, pages 8 - 13
BARBER, DF ET AL., J. IMMUNOL., vol. 176, no. 1, 2006, pages 589 - 93
BARTOK ET AL., ARTHRITIS RHEUM, vol. 62, no. 10, 2010, pages 362
BILANCIO A ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 107, no. 2, 2006, pages 642 - 50
BILLOTTET C ET AL., CANCER RES., vol. 69, no. 3, 2009, pages 1027 - 36
BILLOTTET C ET AL., ONCOGENE, vol. 25, no. 50, 2006, pages 6648 - 59
BOEHNCKE ET AL., CLINICS IN DERMATOLOGY, vol. 25, 2007, pages 596 - 605
BRZEZIANSKA, E; PASTUSZAK-LEWANDOSKA, D, FRONT BIOSCI., vol. 16, 2011, pages 422 - 39
BUCHWALD ET AL., SURGERY, vol. 88, 1980, pages 507
BUNDGARD, H.: "Design of Prod rugs", 1985, ELSEVIER, pages: 7 - 9,21-24
CAMPS ET AL., NATURE MEDICINE, vol. 11, no. 9, 2005, pages 936 - 943
CANCER GENET CYTOGENET., vol. 161, no. 1, August 2005 (2005-08-01), pages 51 - 6
CARRUTHERS: "Some Modern Methods of Organic Synthesis", 1987, CAMBRIDGE UNIVERSITY PRESS
CHA ET AL., ARTHRITIS RHEUM, vol. 46, 2002, pages 1390 - 1398
CHAPUIS, N ET AL., CLIN CANCER RES., vol. 16, no. 22, 2010, pages 5424 - 35
CHEN J.S. ET AL., MOL CANCER THER., vol. 7, no. 4, 2008, pages 841 - 50
CHEN, JS ET AL., MOL CANCER THER., vol. 7, 2008, pages 841 - 850
CHEVALIER ET AL., KIDNEY INTERNATIONAL, vol. 75, 2009, pages 1145 - 1152
CHIORINI ET AL., JOURNAL OF AUTOIMMUNITY, vol. 33, 2009, pages 190 - 196
CHUANG ET AL., CLIN LIVER DIS, vol. 12, 2008, pages 333 - 347
CLAYTON E ET AL., JEXP MED., vol. 196, no. 6, 2002, pages 753 - 63
CONDLIFFE AM ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 106, no. 4, 2005, pages 1432 - 40
COURTNEY, KD ET AL., J CLIN ONCOL., vol. 28, no. 6, 2010, pages 1075 - 1083
DENTON, C.P. ET AL., NATURE CLINICAL PRACTICE RHEUMATOLOGY, vol. 2, no. 3, 2006, pages 134 - 143
DESHMUKH ET AL., J ORAL PATHOL MED, vol. 38, 2009, pages 42 - 27
DIL N; MARSHALL AJ, MOL IMMUNOL., vol. 46, no. 10, 2009, pages 1970 - 8
DOUKAS J ET AL., J PHARMACOL EXP THER., vol. 328, no. 3, 2009, pages 758 - 65
DURAND CA ET AL., J IMMUNOL., vol. 183, no. 9, 2009, pages 5673 - 84
EDGAR ET AL., CANCER RESEARCH, vol. 70, no. 3, 2010, pages 1164 - 1172
FLINN, IW ET AL., J CLIN ONCOL., vol. 27, 2009, pages 156S
FRESNO VARA, JA ET AL., CANCER TREAT REV., vol. 30, no. 2, 2004, pages 193 - 204
FUNG-LEUNG WP, CELL SIGNAL, vol. 23, no. 4, 2011, pages 603 - 8
FURMAN, RR ET AL., 52ND ANNUAL ASH MEETING AND EXPOSITION, December 2010 (2010-12-01), pages 4 - 7
FURUKAWA, T, J GASTROENTEROL., vol. 43, no. 12, 2008, pages 905 - 11
GAESTEL ET AL., CURRENT MEDICINAL CHEMISTRY, vol. 14, 2007, pages 2214 - 2234
GARGON F ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 111, no. 3, 2008, pages 1464 - 71
GARVEY, M.A. ET AL., J CLIN. NEUROL., vol. 13, 1998, pages 413 - 423
GARVEY, M.A. ET AL., J. CHILD NEUROL., vol. 20, 2005, pages 424 - 429
GENG L ET AL., CANCER RES., vol. 64, no. 14, 2004, pages 4893 - 9
GHOREISHI ET AL., LUPUS, vol. 19, 2009, pages 1029 - 1035
GOODMAN; GILMAN'S: "The Pharmacological Basis of Therapeutics"
GOODSON, MEDICAL APPLICATIONS OF CONTROLLED RELEASE, vol. 2, 1984, pages 115 - 138
GREENE; WUTS: "Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis", 1999, JOHN WILEY & SONS
GROOM ET AL., J CLIN INVEST, vol. 109, 2002, pages 59 - 68
GUO H ET AL., J EXP MED., vol. 205, no. 10, 2008, pages 2419 - 35
HALUSKA, F ET AL., SEMIN ONCOL., vol. 34, no. 6, 2007, pages 546 - 54
HARGIS ET AL., AJP, vol. 120, no. 2, 1985, pages 323 - 325
HARRIS, SJ ET AL., CURR OPIN INVESTIG DRUGS, vol. 10, no. 11, 2009, pages 1151 - 62
HAYLOCK-JACOBS S ET AL., J AUTOIMMUN., vol. 36, no. 3-4, 2011, pages 278 - 87
HAYLOCK-JACOBS, S. ET AL., J. AUTOIMMUNITY, vol. 36, no. 3-4, 2011, pages 278 - 87
HE ET AL., LEUKEMIA RESEARCH, vol. 33, 2009, pages 798 - 802
HERMAN SE ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 116, no. 12, 2010, pages 2078 - 88
HERMAN SE ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 117, no. 16, 2011, pages 4323 - 7
HERRERA, VA ET AL., ANTICANCER RES., vol. 31, no. 3, 2011, pages 849 - 54
HIGUCHI, T. ET AL.: "Pro-drugs as Novel Delivery Systems", vol. 14, A.C.S. SYMPOSIUM SERIES
HIRSCHTRITT, M.E. ET AL., CHILD NEUROPSYCHOL., vol. 1, 2008, pages 1 - 16
HOELLENRIEGEL, J ET AL., 52ND ANNUAL ASH MEETING AND EXPOSITION, December 2010 (2010-12-01), pages 4 - 7
HOFFMAN, K.I. ET AL., J. NEUROSCI., vol. 24, 2004, pages 1780 - 1791
HOLLANDER, E. ET AL., AM. J. PSYCHIATRY, vol. 156, 1999, pages 317 - 320
HONG ET AL., J. IMMUNOL., vol. 162, 1999, pages 7480 - 7491
ICHIKAWA ET AL., ARTHRITIS AND RHEUMATISM, vol. 62, no. 2, 2012, pages 493 - 503
IKEDA H ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 116, no. 9, 2010, pages 1460 - 8
IKEDA H. ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 116, no. 9, 2010, pages 1460 - 8
J. PHARMACEUTICAL SCIENCES, vol. 66, 1977, pages 1 - 19
JARMIN SJ ET AL., J CLIN INVEST., vol. 118, no. 3, 2008, pages 1154 - 64
JI H. ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 110, no. 8, 2007, pages 2940 - 7
JIMENO, A ET AL., J CLIN ONCOL., vol. 27, 2009, pages 156S
JONSSON ET AL., CLIN IMMUNOL IMMUNOPATHOL, vol. 42, 1987, pages 93 - 101
KASHISHIAN A ET AL., POSTER PRESENTED AT: THE AMERICAN ASSOCIATION OF CANCER RESEARCH 102ND ANNUAL MEETING, April 2011 (2011-04-01), pages 2 - 6
KHWAJA, A, CURR TOP MICROBIOL IMMUNOL., vol. 347, 2010, pages 169 - 88
KIM MS ET AL., TRENDS IMMUNOL., vol. 29, no. 10, 2008, pages 493 - 501
KIM N ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 110, no. 9, 2007, pages 3202 - 8
KIRVAN. C.A. ET AL., J. NEUROIMMUNOL., vol. 179, 2006, pages 173 - 179
KONG ET AL., CLIN EXP RHEUMATOL, vol. 16, 1998, pages 675 - 681
KONG, D; YAMORI, T, CURR MED CHEM., vol. 16, no. 22, 2009, pages 2839 - 54
KONRAD ET AL., JOURNAL OF BIOLOGICAL CHEMISTRY, vol. 283, no. 48, 2008, pages 33296 - 33303
KONRAD S ET AL., JBIOL CHEM., vol. 283, no. 48, 2008, pages 33296 - 303
KURLAN, R.; KAPLAN, E.L., PEDIATRICS, vol. 113, 2004, pages 883 - 886
LANGER, SCIENCE, vol. 249, 1990, pages 1527 - 1533
LANNUTTI BJ ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 117, no. 2, 2011, pages 591 - 4
LAROCK: "Comprehensive Organic Transformations", 1989, VCH PUBLISHERS, INC.
LEE ET AL., J ALLERGY CLIN IMMUNOL, vol. 118, no. 2, 2006, pages 403 - 9
LEE KS ET AL., FASEB J., vol. 20, no. 3, 2006, pages 455 - 65
LEE KS ET AL., J ALLERGY CLIN IMMUNOL, vol. 118, no. 2, 2006, pages 403 - 9
LESLIE, D.L. ET AL., J. AM. ACAD. CHILD ADOLESC. PSYCHIATRY, vol. 47, 2008, pages 1166 - 1172
LI ET AL., IMMUNITY, vol. 21, 2004, pages 551 - 560
LIU D ET AL., J IMMUNOL., vol. 184, no. 6, 2010, pages 3098 - 105
LUCAS B.S. ET AL., BIOORG. MED. CHEM. LETT., vol. 20, no. 12, 2010, pages 3618 - 22
MARGUTTI, P. ET AL., CURR. NEUROVASC. RES., vol. 3, 2006, pages 149 - 157
MARKMAN, B ET AL., ANN ONCOL., vol. 21, no. 4, 2010, pages 683 - 91
MARTINDALE: "The Extra Pharmacopoeia", 1999, THE PHARMACEUTICAL PRESS
MARWICK JA ET AL., AM J RESPIR CRIT CARE MED., vol. 179, no. 7, 2009, pages 542 - 8
MAZZOLETTI, M; BROGGINI, M, CURR MED CHEM., vol. 17, no. 36, 2010, pages 4433 - 47
MCGRATH-MORROW ET AL., AM J PHYSIOL LUNG CELL MOL PHYSIOL, vol. 291, 2006, pages L837 - 846
MEADOWS ET AL., 52ND ANNUAL ASH MEETING AND EXPOSITION, December 2010 (2010-12-01), pages 4 - 7
MEADOWS, SA ET AL., 52ND ANNUAL ASH MEETING AND EXPOSITION, December 2010 (2010-12-01), pages 4 - 7
MEADOWS, SA, 52ND ANNUAL ASH MEETING AND EXPOSITION, December 2010 (2010-12-01), pages 4 - 7
METHODS ENZYMOL., vol. 434, 2007, pages 131 - 54
MOORE; HOGABOAM, AM. J. PHYSIOL. LUNG. CELL. MOL. PHYSIOL., vol. 294, 2008, pages L152 - L160
MUSTAFA ET AL., TOXICOLOGY, vol. 290, 2011, pages 156 - 168
NATURE MEDICINE, vol. 14, 2008, pages 748 - 755
NIALS ET AL., DIS MODEL MECH., vol. 1, no. 4-5, 2008, pages 213 - 220
NISHIMORI ET AL., J IMMUNOL, vol. 154, 1995, pages 4865 - 4873
OAK ET AL., PROC NATL ACAD SCI USA, vol. 103, 2006, pages 16882 - 16887
OH-HORA ET AL., NAT. IMMUNOL, vol. 9, 2008, pages 432 - 443
OHL ET AL., JOURNAL OF BIOMEDICINE AND BIOTECHNOLOGY, 2011, pages 14
OKKENHAUG K ET AL., J IMMUNOL., vol. 177, no. 8, 2006, pages 5122 - 8
OKKENHAUG K. ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 297, no. 5583, 2002, pages 1031 - 4
OMENETTI, A. ET AL., LABORATORY INVESTIGATION, vol. 87, 2007, pages 499 - 514
ORLANDO, FL; KAHL, B ET AL., 52ND ANNUAL ASH MEETING AND EXPOSITION, December 2010 (2010-12-01), pages 4 - 7
OUYANG ET AL., J MOL MED, 2012, pages 10
PAN S. ET AL., ACS MED. CHEM. LETT., vol. 1, no. 3, 2010, pages 130 - 134
PAU ET AL., PLOS ONE, vol. 7, no. 5, 2012, pages 15
PETERSON, B.S. ET AL., ARCH. GEN. PSYCHIATRY, vol. 57, 2000, pages 364 - 372
PHYANAGI ET AL., ARTHRITIS & RHEUMATISM, vol. 60, no. 10, 2009, pages 3118 - 3127
PINHO V, J IMMUNOL., vol. 179, no. 11, 2007, pages 7891 - 8
PODOLIN ET AL., J EXP MED, vol. 178, 1993, pages 793 - 803
PORTA, C; FIGLIN, RA, J UROL., vol. 182, no. 6, 2009, pages 2569 - 77
RANDIS TM ET AL., EUR J IMMUNOL., vol. 38, no. 5, 2008, pages 1215 - 24
RANKIN ET AL., JOURNAL OF IMMUNOLOGY, vol. 188, 2012, pages 1656 - 1667
RAPID COMMUN. MASS SPECTROM., vol. 10, pages 1019 - 1026
RASOOLY ET AL., CLIN IMMUNOL IMMUNOPATHOL, vol. 81, 1996, pages 287 - 292
REIF K, J IMMUNOL., vol. 173, no. 4, 2004, pages 2236 - 40
ROBARGE K.D. ET AL., BIOORG MED CHEM LETT., vol. 19, no. 19, 2009, pages 5576 - 81
ROMINGER C.M. ET AL., J. PHARMACOL. EXP. THER., vol. 329, no. 3, 2009, pages 995 - 1005
ROMMEL C. ET AL., NAT REV IMMUNOL, vol. 7, no. 3, 2007, pages 191 - 201
RUDIN, C. ET AL., NEW ENGLAND J OF MEDICINE, 2009, pages 361 - 366
S. BOLLAND; J.V. RAVTECH, IMMUNITY, vol. 12, 2000, pages 277 - 285
SADHU C. ET AL., J IMMUNOL., vol. 170, no. 5, 2003, pages 2647 - 54
SAIF, MW; CHU, E, CANCER J., vol. 16, no. 3, 2010, pages 196 - 201
SALMENA, L ET AL., CELL, vol. 133, 2008, pages 403 - 414
SARKER, D ET AL., CLIN CANCER RES., vol. 15, no. 15, 2009, pages 4799 - 805
SAUDEK ET AL., N. ENGL. J. MED., vol. 321, 1989, pages 574
SAUDEMONT A, PROC NATL ACAD SCI USA., vol. 106, no. 14, 2009, pages 5795 - 800
SEFTON, CRC CRIT. REF. BIOMED. ENG., vol. 14, 1987, pages 201
SHAPIRO, G ET AL., J CLIN ONCOL., vol. 27, 2009, pages 146S
SHEN ET AL., J IMMUNOL, vol. 177, 2006, pages 5676 - 5686
SIU L. ET AL., J. CLIN. ONCOL., vol. 28, 2010, pages 15S
SMITH; MARCH: "March's Advanced Organic Chemistry", 2001, JOHN WILEY & SONS, INC.
SOKOL, M.S. ET AL., AM. J. PSYCHIATRY, vol. 159, 2002, pages 1430 - 1432
SOKOL, M.S., J. CHILD ADOLESC. PSYCHOPHARMACOL., vol. 10, 2000, pages 133 - 145
SOOND DR ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 115, no. 11, 2010, pages 2203 - 13
SRINIVASAN L ET AL., CELL, vol. 139, no. 3, 2009, pages 573 - 86
T. WU ET AL., J. CLIN INVEST., vol. 117, pages 2186 - 2196
T.H. GREENE; P. G. M. WUTS: "Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis", 1999, JOHN WILEY & SONS
TASSI I ET AL., IMMUNITY, vol. 27, no. 2, 2007, pages 214 - 27
THOMAS SORRELL: "Organic Chemistry", 1999, UNIVERSITY SCIENCE BOOKS
TORBETT, NE ET AL., BIOCHEM J., vol. 415, 2008, pages 97 - 100
VANHAESEBROECK, B. ET AL., ANNU REV BIOCHEM., vol. 70, 2001, pages 535 - 602
VANHAESEBROECK, B. ET AL., CURRENT TOPICS IN MICROBIOLOGY AND IMMUNOLOGY, 2010
VARICCHIO, L. ET AL., EXPERT REV. HEMATOL., vol. 2, no. 3, 2009, pages 315 - 334
VOGT, PK ET AL., CURR TOP MICROBIOL IMMUNOL., vol. 347, 2010, pages 79 - 104
VOGT, PK ET AL., VIROLOGY, vol. 344, no. 1, 2006, pages 131 - 8
VON HOFF D. ET AL., N. ENGL. J. MED., vol. 361, no. 12, 2009, pages 1164 - 72
WAGNER, AJ ET AL., J CLIN ONCOL., vol. 27, 2009, pages 146S
WARD S ET AL., CHEM BIOL., vol. 10, no. 3, 2003, pages 207 - 13
WARD, S ET AL., CHEM BIOL., vol. 10, no. 3, 2003, pages 207 - 13
WEBB LM ET AL., J IMMUNOL., vol. 175, no. 5, 2005, pages 2783 - 7
WEBB, HK ET AL., 52ND ANNUAL ASH MEETING AND EXPOSITION, December 2010 (2010-12-01), pages 4 - 7
WENZEL ET AL., LUPUS, vol. 19, 2010, pages 1020 - 1028
WILEN ET AL., TETRAHEDRON, vol. 33, 1977, pages 2725
WILLIAMS ET AL., CHEM BIOL, vol. 17, no. 2, 2010, pages 123 - 34
WILLIAMS, O. ET AL., CHEM BIOL, vol. 17, no. 2, 2010, pages 123 - 34
XIA ET AL., RHEUMATOLOGY, vol. 50, 2011, pages 2187 - 2196
YADDANAPUDI, K. ET AL., MO/. PSYCHIATRY, vol. 15, 2010, pages 712 - 726
YAMAMOTO ET AL., J INVEST DERMATOL, vol. 112, 1999, pages 456 - 462
YAUCH, R. L. ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 326, 2009, pages 572 - 574
ZHANG TT ET AL., J ALLERGY CLIN IMMUNOL., vol. 122, no. 4, 2008, pages 811 - 819.E2
ZHAO, L; VOGT, PK, ONCOGENE, vol. 27, no. 41, 2008, pages 5486 - 96

Cited By (35)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US9670163B2 (en) 2005-12-28 2017-06-06 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Solid forms of N-[2,4-bis(1,1-dimethylethyl)-5-hydroxyphenyl]-1,4-dihydro-4-oxoquinoline-3-carboxamide
US10221197B2 (en) 2014-06-13 2019-03-05 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
US11021467B2 (en) 2014-06-13 2021-06-01 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
US10308639B2 (en) 2014-06-13 2019-06-04 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
US10092563B2 (en) 2014-06-13 2018-10-09 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
US20160024054A1 (en) * 2014-06-24 2016-01-28 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
US9765060B2 (en) 2014-06-24 2017-09-19 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase inhibitors
US9944639B2 (en) 2014-07-04 2018-04-17 Lupin Limited Quinolizinone derivatives as PI3K inhibitors
WO2017112950A1 (fr) * 2015-12-24 2017-06-29 The Regents Of The University Of California Régulateurs cftr et méthodes pour les utiliser
US11084795B2 (en) 2015-12-24 2021-08-10 The Regents Of The University Of California CFTR regulators and methods of use thereof
US11230535B2 (en) 2015-12-24 2022-01-25 The Regents Of The University Of California CFTR regulators and methods of use thereof
RU2730855C2 (ru) * 2015-12-24 2020-08-26 Дзе Риджентс Оф Дзе Юниверсити Оф Калифорниа Кфтр регуляторы и способы их применения
WO2017112951A1 (fr) * 2015-12-24 2017-06-29 The Regents Of The University Of California Régulateurs cftr et leurs méthodes d'utilisation
US10604492B2 (en) 2015-12-24 2020-03-31 The Regents Of The Universtiy Of California CFTR regulators and methods of use thereof
AU2017256488B2 (en) * 2016-04-29 2020-12-17 Yuhan Corporation Quinazoline derivative or its salt and pharmaceutical composition comprising the same
US10941136B2 (en) 2016-04-29 2021-03-09 Yuhan Corporation Quinazoline derivative or its salt and pharmaceutical composition comprising the same
JP2019514910A (ja) * 2016-04-29 2019-06-06 ユーハン・コーポレイションYUHAN Corporation キナゾリン誘導体またはその塩およびそれを含む医薬組成物
CN109071462A (zh) * 2016-04-29 2018-12-21 柳韩洋行 喹唑啉衍生物或其盐和包含其的药物组合物
WO2017188720A3 (fr) * 2016-04-29 2018-07-26 Yuhan Corporation Dérivé de quinazoline ou son sel et composition pharmaceutique le comprenant
CN109071462B (zh) * 2016-04-29 2022-02-08 柳韩洋行 喹唑啉衍生物或其盐和包含其的药物组合物
CN111386264A (zh) * 2017-07-31 2020-07-07 纽约市哥伦比亚大学理事会 用于治疗t-细胞急性淋巴细胞白血病的化合物、组合物和方法
US11839616B2 (en) 2017-08-24 2023-12-12 The Regents Of The University Of California Ocular pharmaceutical compositions
CN110003192A (zh) * 2018-01-04 2019-07-12 广东东阳光药业有限公司 取代的氨基嘧啶类化合物及其使用方法和用途
JP2021511312A (ja) * 2018-01-17 2021-05-06 バーテックス ファーマシューティカルズ インコーポレイテッドVertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated ゲノム編集効率を増加するためのキノキサリノン化合物、組成物、方法、およびキット
JP2021512052A (ja) * 2018-01-20 2021-05-13 サンシャイン・レイク・ファーマ・カンパニー・リミテッドSunshine Lake Pharma Co.,Ltd. 置換アミノピリミジン化合物及び使用方法
JP7450541B2 (ja) 2018-01-20 2024-03-15 サンシャイン・レイク・ファーマ・カンパニー・リミテッド 置換アミノピリミジン化合物及び使用方法
CN115210280A (zh) * 2020-03-05 2022-10-18 波音公司 席夫碱低聚物
US11691971B2 (en) 2020-06-19 2023-07-04 Incyte Corporation Naphthyridinone compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11753413B2 (en) 2020-06-19 2023-09-12 Incyte Corporation Substituted pyrrolo[2,1-f][1,2,4]triazine compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11767323B2 (en) 2020-07-02 2023-09-26 Incyte Corporation Tricyclic pyridone compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11780840B2 (en) 2020-07-02 2023-10-10 Incyte Corporation Tricyclic urea compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11661422B2 (en) 2020-08-27 2023-05-30 Incyte Corporation Tricyclic urea compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
WO2022117016A1 (fr) * 2020-12-02 2022-06-09 深圳微芯生物科技股份有限公司 Composé hydroxamate, son procédé de préparation et son application
US11919908B2 (en) 2020-12-21 2024-03-05 Incyte Corporation Substituted pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidine compounds as JAK2 V617F inhibitors
US11958861B2 (en) 2022-02-24 2024-04-16 Incyte Corporation Spirocyclic lactams as JAK2 V617F inhibitors

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US9605003B2 (en) Heterocyclic compounds and uses thereof
US9546180B2 (en) Heterocyclic compounds and uses thereof
EP2836487B1 (fr) Composés hétérocycliques et leurs utilisations
US9718815B2 (en) Heterocyclic compounds and uses thereof
WO2015168079A1 (fr) Dérivés de pyrimidine ou de pyridine utiles en tant qu'inhibiteurs de pi3k
WO2015051244A1 (fr) Composés hétérocycliques et leurs utilisations
AU2014329392A1 (en) Heterocyclic compounds and uses thereof
WO2015051241A1 (fr) Composés hétérocycliques et leurs utilisations
WO2015061204A1 (fr) Composés hétérocycliques et leurs utilisations
CA2842187A1 (fr) Composes heterocycliques et leurs utilisations
NZ621521B2 (en) 1-oxo-isoquinolines and uses thereof

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 15721101

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

122 Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase

Ref document number: 15721101

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1